Compositions and methods for treating toxoplasmosis, cryptosporidiosis, and other apicomplexan protozoan related diseases
11247972 · 2022-02-15
Assignee
Inventors
- Wesley C. Van Voorhis (Seattle, WA)
- Wilhelmus G. J. Hol (Kenmore, WA)
- Eric T. Larson (Shoreline, WA, US)
- Dustin James Maly (Seattle, WA)
- Ethan Merritt (Seattle, WA)
- Kayode K. Ojo (Federal Way, WA)
Cpc classification
C07D235/32
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
A61P33/02
HUMAN NECESSITIES
C07D403/12
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
Y02A50/30
GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
C07D235/30
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
International classification
C07D235/30
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D235/32
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
C07D401/12
CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
Abstract
Compositions and methods for the treatment of toxoplasmosis, caused by the infectious eukaryotic parasite Toxoplasma gondii (T. gondii) and for the treatment of cryptosporidiosis, caused by the infectious eukaryotic parasites Cryptosporidium parvum (C. parvum) and Cryptosporidium hominus (C. hominus) are described. In particular, the present disclosure is directed to compositions and methods for inhibiting either T. gondii calcium dependent protein kinases (TgCDPKs) or C. parvum and C. hominus calcium dependent protein kinases (CpCDPKs) using pyrazolopyrimidine and/or imidazo[1,5-a]pyrazine inhibitors, of the formula, ##STR00001## wherein the variables X, Y, Z, L, R.sup.1, and R.sup.3 are defined herein.
Claims
1. A compound of the formula ##STR00376## or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12, wherein R.sup.12 is —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2, phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the aryl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2; R.sup.3 is one of the formulas, ##STR00377## wherein n is 0, 1, or 2; Q is —O—, —S—, or —N(R.sup.Q)—, wherein R.sup.Q is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the alkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl, each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, —OC(O)R.sup.34, —OC(O)OR.sup.34, —OC(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)R.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)OR.sup.34, or —N(R.sup.34)C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and R.sup.35 is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and each R is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the alkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.0, —SR.sup.0, —N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.0, —C(O)OR.sup.0, —C(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.0, —OC(O)R.sup.0, —OC(O)OR.sup.0, —OC(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —N(R.sup.0)C(O)R.sup.0, —N(R.sup.0)C(O)OR.sup.0, or —N(R.sup.0)C(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.0 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
2. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sup.3 is ##STR00378##
3. The compound of claim 1, wherein R.sup.3 is ##STR00379##
4. The compound of claim 3, wherein Q is —O— or —N(R.sup.Q)—.
5. The compound of claim 4, wherein R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
6. The compound of claim 3, wherein R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12.
7. The compound of claim 6, wherein R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2.
8. The compound of claim 6, wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2.
9. A compound, which is: 6-(4-amino-1-(piperidin-4-ylmethyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-3-yl)-N,N-dimethylquinolin-2-amine; 1-isopropyl-3-(quinolin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-amine; 1-(piperidin-4-ylmethyl)-3-(quinolin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-amine; ##STR00380## or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
10. A method for treating an apicomplexan protozoan related disease comprising providing to a patient in need of such treatment a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 1, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising said compound and a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient, carrier, or diluent.
11. The method of claim 10, wherein the apicomplexan protozoan related disease is toxoplasmosis, cryptosporidiosis, coccidiosis, or malaria.
12. The compound of claim 1, wherein n is 0 or 1.
13. The compound of claim 12, wherein R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12; and R.sup.3 is ##STR00381##
14. The compound of claim 13, wherein R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl.
15. The compound of claim 14, wherein Q is —O— or —N(R.sup.Q)—.
16. The compound of claim 15, wherein R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
17. The compound of claim 16, wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2.
18. The compound of claim 16, wherein R.sup.12 is ##STR00382## wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
19. The compound of claim 18, wherein Q is —O—.
20. The compound of claim 18, wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
21. The compound of claim 20, wherein Q is —O—, —N(H)— or —N(CH.sub.3)—.
22. The compound of claim 20, wherein Q is —O—.
Description
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13) .
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
(18)
(19)
(20)
(21)
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
(22) The following description provides specific details for a thorough understanding of, and enabling description for, embodiments of the disclosure. However, one skilled in the art will understand that the disclosure may be practiced without these details. In other instances, well-known structures and functions have not been shown or described in detail to avoid unnecessarily obscuring the description of the embodiments of the disclosure.
(23) In one aspect, the present disclosure provides compounds of the formula (I),
(24) ##STR00004##
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein X, Y, and Z are defined by either: (i) X is N, Y is C, and Z is N; or (ii) X is C, Y is N, and Z is C(H); R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.2-6 alkynyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, or phenyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups; each R.sup.11 is independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R; and R.sup.12 is —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, —N(R)C(O) NR.sub.2, phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the aryl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2; R.sup.3 is one of the formulas,
(25) ##STR00005##
wherein n is 0, 1, or 2; Q is —O—, —S—, or —N(R.sup.Q)—, wherein R.sup.Q is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the alkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, —OC(O)R.sup.34, —OC(O)OR.sup.34, —OC(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)R.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34)C(O) OR.sup.34, or —N(R.sup.34)C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and R.sup.35 is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl;
and each R is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the alkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.0, —SR.sup.0, —N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.0, —C(O)OR.sup.0, —C(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.0, —OC(O)R.sup.0, —OC(O)OR.sup.0, —OC(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —N(R.sup.0)C(O)R.sup.0, —N(R.sup.0)C(O)OR.sup.0, or —N(R.sup.0)C(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.0 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl,
provided that the compound is not
(26) ##STR00006## ##STR00007##
(27) The disclosure further comprises subgenera of formula (I) in which the substituents are selected as any and all combinations of one or more of structural formula (I), n, Q, R.sup.1, R.sup.3, R.sup.32, and R.sup.33 as defined herein, including without limitation, the following:
(28) Structural Formula I is One of Formulae (Ia)-(Ib):
(29) ##STR00008##
R.sup.1 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (1a)-(1ii): (1a) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-4 alkyl, —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12, C.sub.2-4 alkynyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, or phenyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (1b) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, or phenyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (1c) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl; or a monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (1d) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl. (1e) R.sup.1 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (1f) R.sup.1 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (1g) R.sup.1 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (1h) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl. (1i) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-4 alkyl. (1j) R.sup.1 is isopropyl or t-butyl. (1k) R.sup.1 is t-butyl. (1l) R.sup.1 is isopropyl. (1m) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl or —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (1n) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (1o) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-2 alkyl-R.sup.12. (1p) R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12 (1q) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2; (1r) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), R.sup.12 is —C(O)OR or —C(O)NR.sub.2. (1s) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1t) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1u) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), R.sup.12 is phenyl or monocyclic heterocyclyl, each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1v) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1w) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1x) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), R.sup.12 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1y) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1z) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (1aa) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1bb) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (1cc) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (1dd) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (1ee) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(30) ##STR00009##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (1ff) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(31) ##STR00010##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (1gg) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(32) ##STR00011##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (1hh) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(33) ##STR00012##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (1ii) Any one of groups (1m)-(1p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(34) ##STR00013##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
R.sup.3 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (2a)-(2Aa): (2a) R.sup.3 is one of groups (R.sup.3-a) through (R.sup.3-g) as defined above. (2b) R.sup.3 is one of groups (R.sup.3-b) through (R.sup.3-g) as defined above. (2c) R.sup.3 is
(35) ##STR00014## (2d) R.sup.3 is
(36) ##STR00015## (2e) R.sup.3 is
(37) ##STR00016## (2f) R.sup.3 is
(38) ##STR00017## (2i) R.sup.3 is
(39) ##STR00018## (2g) R.sup.3 is
(40) ##STR00019## (2j) R.sup.3 is
(41) ##STR00020## (2h) R.sup.3 is
(42) ##STR00021## (2k) R.sup.3 is
(43) ##STR00022## (2l) R.sup.3 is
(44) ##STR00023## (2m) R.sup.3 is
(45) ##STR00024## (2n) R.sup.3 is
(46) ##STR00025## (2o) R.sup.3 is
(47) ##STR00026## (2p) R.sup.3 is
(48) ##STR00027## (2q) R.sup.3 is
(49) ##STR00028## (2r) R.sup.3 is
(50) ##STR00029## (2s) R.sup.3 is
(51) ##STR00030## (2t) R.sup.3 is
(52) ##STR00031## (2u) Any one of groups (2l)-(2t), wherein R.sup.35 is hydrogen or methyl. (2v) Any one of groups (2l)-(2t), wherein R.sup.35 is methyl. (2w) Any one of groups (2l)-(2t), wherein R.sup.35 is hydrogen. (2x) R.sup.3 is
(53) ##STR00032## (2y) Group (2x) wherein R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, aryl, or arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (2z) Group (2x) wherein R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, phenyl, or benzyl. (2aa) Group (2x) wherein R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-4 alkyl, C.sub.1-4 haloalkyl, C.sub.5-6 cycloalkyl, phenyl, or benzyl.
Q is Selected from One of the Following Groups (3a)-(3e): (3a) Q is —O— or —N(R.sup.Q)—. (3b) Q is —O— or —N(H)—. (3c) Q is —O—. (3d) Q is —N(R.sup.Q)—. (3e) Q is —N(H)—.
n and R.sup.32 are Selected from One of the Following Groups (4a)-(4x): (4a) n is 0. (4b) n is 0 or 1 and R.sup.32 is as defined for formula (I). (4c) n is 0 or 1 and R.sup.32 is halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4d) n is 0 or 1 and R.sup.32 is halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4e) n is 0 or 1 and each R.sup.32 is —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, —OC(O)R.sup.34, —OC(O)OR.sup.34, —OC(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)R.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)OR.sup.34, or —N(R.sup.34)C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4f) n is 0 or 1 and R.sup.32 is —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4g) n is 0 or 1 and R.sup.32 is —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4h) n is as defined for formula (I) and each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4i) n is as defined for formula (I) and each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4j) n is as defined for formula (I) and each R.sup.32 is independently —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, —OC(O)R.sup.34, —OC(O)OR.sup.34, —OC(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)R.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)OR.sup.34, or —N(R.sup.34)C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4k) n is as defined for formula (I) and each R.sup.32 is independently —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4l) n is as defined for formula (I) and each R.sup.32 is independently —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4m) n is 1 or 2 and each R.sup.32 is as defined for formula (I). (4n) n is 1 or 2 and each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4o) n is 1 or 2 and each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4p) n is 1 or 2 and each R.sup.32 is independently —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, —OC(O)R.sup.34, —OC(O)OR.sup.34, —OC(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)R.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)OR.sup.34, or —N(R.sup.34)C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4q) n is 1 or 2 and each R.sup.32 is independently —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4r) n is 1 or 2 and each R.sup.32 is independently —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4s) n is 1 and R.sup.32 is as defined for formula (I). (4t) n is 1 and R.sup.32 is halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4u) n is 1 and R.sup.32 is halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (4v) n is 1 and R.sup.32 is —OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, —OC(O)R.sup.34, —OC(O)OR.sup.34, —OC(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)R.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34)C(O)OR.sup.34, or —N(R.sup.34)C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4w) n is 1 and R.sup.32 is-OR.sup.34, —SR.sup.34, —N(R.sup.34).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (4x) n is 1 and R.sup.32 is —C(O)R.sup.34, —C(O)OR.sup.34, —C(O)N(R.sup.34).sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.34, wherein each R.sup.34 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
R.sup.33 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (5a)-(5t): (5a) R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —O C(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5b) R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —O C(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5c) R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5d) R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5e) R.sup.33 is C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —O C(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5f) R.sup.33 is C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —O C(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5g) R.sup.33 is C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5h) R.sup.33 is C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5i) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, each are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5j) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, each are each substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —O C(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl (5k) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, each optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5l) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5m) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —O C(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5n) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl (5o) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5p) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5q) R.sup.33 is benzyl optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5r) R.sup.33 is benzyl substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.20, —C(O)OR.sup.20, —C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.20, —OC(O)R.sup.20, —OC(O)OR.sup.20, —OC(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)R.sup.20, —N(R.sup.20)C(O)OR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20)C(O)N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (5s) R.sup.33 is benzyl optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (5t) R.sup.33 is benzyl substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl.
(54) Particular embodiments of this aspect of the invention include compounds of any one of the formulae (I), (Ia), and (Ib), each as defined in each of the following rows, wherein each entry is a group number as defined above (e.g., (3c) refers to Q is —O—), a dash “-” indicates that the variable is as defined for formula (I) or defined according to any one of the applicable variable definitions (1a)-(5t) [e.g., when R.sup.1 is a dash, it can be either as defined for Formula (I) or any one of definitions (1a)-(1ii)]; and an “x” indicates that the variable is not applicable to the articular embodiment (e.g., when R.sup.3 is (2o), then Q and R.sup.33 are not necessary):
(55) TABLE-US-00001 R.sup.1 R.sup.3 R.sup.33 n & R.sup.32 Q (1)-1 1h 2b 5a 4c 3a (1)-2 1n 2b 5a 4c 3a (1)-3 1p 2b 5a 4c 3a (1)-4 1aa 2b 5a 4c 3a (1)-5 1h 2b 5e 4c 3a (1)-6 1n 2b 5e 4c 3a (1)-7 1p 2b 5e 4c 3a (1)-8 1aa 2b 5e 4c 3a (1)-9 1h 2b 5i 4c 3a (1)-10 1n 2b 5i 4c 3a (1)-11 1p 2b 5i 4c 3a (1)-12 1aa 2b 5i 4c 3a (1)-13 1h 2b 5q 4c 3a (1)-14 1n 2b 5q 4c 3a (1)-15 1p 2b 5q 4c 3a (1)-16 1aa 2b 5q 4c 3a (1)-17 1h 2c 5a 4c 3a (1)-18 1n 2c 5a 4c 3a (1)-19 1p 2c 5a 4c 3a (1)-20 1aa 2c 5a 4c 3a (1)-21 1h 2c 5e 4c 3a (1)-22 1n 2c 5e 4c 3a (1)-23 1p 2c 5e 4c 3a (1)-24 1aa 2c 5e 4c 3a (1)-25 1h 2c 5i 4c 3a (1)-26 1n 2c 5i 4c 3a (1)-27 1p 2c 5i 4c 3a (1)-28 1aa 2c 5i 4c 3a (1)-29 1h 2c 5q 4c 3a (1)-30 1n 2c 5q 4c 3a (1)-31 1p 2c 5q 4c 3a (1)-32 1aa 2c 5q 4c 3a (1)-33 1h 2b 5a 4n 3a (1)-34 1n 2b 5a 4n 3a (1)-35 1p 2b 5a 4n 3a (1)-36 1aa 2b 5a 4n 3a (1)-37 1h 2b 5e 4n 3a (1)-38 1n 2b 5e 4n 3a (1)-39 1p 2b 5e 4n 3a (1)-40 1aa 2b 5e 4n 3a (1)-41 1h 2b 5i 4n 3a (1)-42 1n 2b 5i 4n 3a (1)-43 1p 2b 5i 4n 3a (1)-44 1aa 2b 5i 4n 3a (1)-45 1h 2b 5q 4n 3a (1)-46 1n 2b 5q 4n 3a (1)-47 1p 2b 5q 4n 3a (1)-48 1aa 2b 5q 4n 3a (1)-49 1h 2c 5a 4n 3a (1)-50 1n 2c 5a 4n 3a (1)-51 1p 2c 5a 4n 3a (1)-52 1aa 2c 5a 4n 3a (1)-53 1h 2c 5e 4n 3a (1)-54 1n 2c 5e 4n 3a (1)-55 1p 2c 5e 4n 3a (1)-56 1aa 2c 5e 4n 3a (1)-57 1h 2c 5i 4n 3a (1)-58 1n 2c 5i 4n 3a (1)-59 1p 2c 5i 4n 3a (1)-60 1aa 2c 5i 4n 3a (1)-61 1h 2c 5q 4n 3a (1)-62 1n 2c 5q 4n 3a (1)-63 1p 2c 5q 4n 3a (1)-64 1aa 2c 5q 4n 3a (1)-65 1h 2b 5a 4c 3c (1)-66 1n 2b 5a 4c 3c (1)-67 1p 2b 5a 4c 3c (1)-68 1aa 2b 5a 4c 3c (1)-69 1h 2b 5e 4c 3c (1)-70 1n 2b 5e 4c 3c (1)-71 1p 2b 5e 4c 3c (1)-72 1aa 2b 5e 4c 3c (1)-73 1h 2b 5i 4c 3c (1)-74 1n 2b 5i 4c 3c (1)-75 1p 2b 5i 4c 3c (1)-76 1aa 2b 5i 4c 3c (1)-77 1h 2b 5q 4c 3c (1)-78 1n 2b 5q 4c 3c (1)-79 1p 2b 5q 4c 3c (1)-80 1aa 2b 5q 4c 3c (1)-81 1h 2c 5a 4c 3c (1)-82 1n 2c 5a 4c 3c (1)-83 1p 2c 5a 4c 3c (1)-84 1aa 2c 5a 4c 3c (1)-85 1h 2c 5e 4c 3c (1)-86 1n 2c 5e 4c 3c (1)-87 1p 2c 5e 4c 3c (1)-88 1aa 2c 5e 4c 3c (1)-89 1h 2c 5i 4c 3c (1)-90 1n 2c 5i 4c 3c (1)-91 1p 2c 5i 4c 3c (1)-92 1aa 2c 5i 4c 3c (1)-93 1h 2c 5q 4c 3c (1)-94 1n 2c 5q 4c 3c (1)-95 1p 2c 5q 4c 3c (1)-96 1aa 2c 5q 4c 3c (1)-97 1h 2b 5a 4n 3c (1)-98 1n 2b 5a 4n 3c (1)-99 1p 2b 5a 4n 3c (1)-100 1aa 2b 5a 4n 3c (1)-101 1h 2b 5e 4n 3c (1)-102 1n 2b 5e 4n 3c (1)-103 1p 2b 5e 4n 3c (1)-104 1aa 2b 5e 4n 3c (1)-105 1h 2b 5i 4n 3c (1)-106 1n 2b 5i 4n 3c (1)-107 1p 2b 5i 4n 3c (1)-108 1aa 2b 5i 4n 3c (1)-109 1h 2b 5q 4n 3c (1)-110 1n 2b 5q 4n 3c (1)-111 1p 2b 5q 4n 3c (1)-112 1aa 2b 5q 4n 3c (1)-113 1h 2c 5a 4n 3c (1)-114 1n 2c 5a 4n 3c (1)-115 1p 2c 5a 4n 3c (1)-116 1aa 2c 5a 4n 3c (1)-117 1h 2c 5e 4n 3c (1)-118 1n 2c 5e 4n 3c (1)-119 1p 2c 5e 4n 3c (1)-120 1aa 2c 5e 4n 3c (1)-121 1h 2c 5i 4n 3c (1)-122 1n 2c 5i 4n 3c (1)-123 1p 2c 5i 4n 3c (1)-124 1aa 2c 5i 4n 3c (1)-125 1h 2c 5q 4n 3c (1)-126 1n 2c 5q 4n 3c (1)-127 1p 2c 5q 4n 3c (1)-128 1aa 2c 5q 4n 3c (1)-129 1h 2b — — — (1)-130 1n 2b — — — (1)-131 1p 2b — — — (1)-132 1aa 2b — — — (1)-133 1h 2c — — — (1)-134 1n 2c — — — (1)-135 1p 2c — — — (1)-136 1aa 2c — — — (1)-137 1h 2b — — 3c (1)-138 1n 2b — — 3c (1)-139 1p 2b — — 3c (1)-140 1aa 2b — — 3c (1)-141 1h 2c — — 3c (1)-142 1n 2c — — 3c (1)-143 1p 2c — — 3c (1)-144 1aa 2c — — 3c (1)-145 1h 2b — — 3a (1)-146 1n 2b — — 3a (1)-147 1p 2b — — 3a (1)-148 1aa 2b — — 3a (1)-149 1h 2c — — 3a (1)-150 1n 2c — — 3a (1)-151 1p 2c — — 3a (1)-152 1aa 2c — — 3a (1)-153 — — 5a — 3a (1)-154 — — 5e — 3a (1)-155 — — 5i — 3a (1)-156 — — 5q — 3a (1)-157 — — 5a — 3c (1)-158 — — 5e — 3a (1)-159 — — 5i — 3a (1)-160 — — 5q — 3a (1)-161 — 2b 5a — 3a (1)-162 — 2b 5e — 3a (1)-163 — 2b 5i — 3a (1)-164 — 2b 5q — 3a (1)-165 — 2b 5a — 3c (1)-166 — 2b 5e — 3a (1)-167 — 2b 5i — 3a (1)-168 — 2b 5q — 3a (1)-169 — 2c 5a — 3a (1)-170 — 2c 5e — 3a (1)-171 — 2c 5i — 3a (1)-172 — 2c 5q — 3a (1)-173 — 2c 5a — 3c (1)-174 — 2c 5e — 3a (1)-175 — 2c 5i — 3a (1)-176 — 2c 5q — 3a (1)-177 1h 2o x 4c x (1)-178 1n 2o x 4c x (1)-179 1p 2o x 4c x (1)-180 1aa 2o x 4c x (1)-185 1h 2o x 4n x (1)-186 1n 2o x 4n x (1)-187 1p 2o x 4n x (1)-188 1aa 2o x 4n x (1)-189 1h 2r x 4n x (1)-190 1n 2r x 4n x (1)-191 1p 2r x 4n x (1)-192 1aa 2r x 4n x (1)-181 1h 2r x 4c x (1)-182 1n 2r x 4c x (1)-183 1p 2r x 4c x (1)-184 1aa 2r x 4c x (1)-193 1h 2o x — x (1)-194 1n 2o x — x (1)-195 1p 2o x — x (1)-196 1aa 2o x — x (1)-197 1h 2r x — x (1)-198 1n 2r x — x (1)-199 1p 2r x — x (1)-200 1aa 2r x — x
(56) In one embodiment, the compound is one of the compounds in Table A:
(57) TABLE-US-00002 TABLE A
(58) In another embodiment, the present disclosure provides compounds of the formula (III),
(59) ##STR00073##
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein X, Y, and Z are defined by either: (i) X is N, Y is C, and Z is N; or (ii) X is C, Y is N, and Z is C(H); R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl or —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12, wherein R.sup.12 is a monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2; R.sup.3 is one of the formulas,
(60) ##STR00074##
wherein n is 0, 1, or 2; Q is —O— or —N(R.sup.Q)—, wherein R.sup.Q is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.20, —SR.sup.20, or —N(R.sup.20).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.20 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. each R.sup.32 is independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or —OR.sup.34, wherein R.sup.34 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl; and R.sup.35 is hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl;
and
each R is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
(61) The disclosure further comprises subgenera of formula (III) in which the substituents are selected as any and all combinations of one or more of structural formula (III), n, Q, R.sup.1, R.sup.3, R.sup.32, and R.sup.33 as defined herein, including without limitation, the following:
(62) Structural Formula III is One of Formulae (IIIa)-(IIIb):
(63) ##STR00075##
R.sup.1 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (8a)-(8u): (8a) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl. (8b) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-4 alkyl. (8c) R.sup.1 is isopropyl or t-butyl. (8d) R.sup.1 is t-butyl. (8e) R.sup.1 is isopropyl. (8f) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (8g) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-2 alkyl-R.sup.12. (8h) R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12. (8i) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (8j) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), R.sup.12 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (8k) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (8l) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (8m) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (8n) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (8o) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (8p) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (8q) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is
(64) ##STR00076##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (8r) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is
(65) ##STR00077##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (8s) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is
(66) ##STR00078##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (8t) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is
(67) ##STR00079##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (8u) Any one of groups (8f)-(8h), wherein R.sup.12 is
(68) ##STR00080##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
R.sup.3 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (9a)-(9g): (9a) R.sup.3 is
(69) ##STR00081## (9b) R.sup.3 is
(70) ##STR00082## (9c) R.sup.3 is
(71) ##STR00083## (9d) R.sup.3 is
(72) ##STR00084## (9e) Any one of groups (9b)-(9d), wherein R.sup.35 is hydrogen or methyl. (9f) Any one of groups (9b)-(9d), wherein R.sup.35 is methyl. (9g) Any one of groups (9b)-(9d), wherein R.sup.35 is hydrogen.
Q is Selected from One of the Following Groups (10a)-(10d): (10a) Q is —O— or —N(H)—. (10b) Q is —O—. (10c) Q is —N(R.sup.Q)—. (10d) Q is —N(H)—.
n and R.sup.32 are Selected from One of the Following Groups (11a)-(11c): (11a) n is 0. (11b) n is 0 or 1 and R.sup.32 is as defined for formula (III). (11c) n is 1 or 2 and R.sup.32 is as defined for formula (III).
R.sup.33 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (12a)-(12j): (12a) R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12b) R.sup.33 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12c) R.sup.33 is C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12d) R.sup.33 is C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, wherein the arylalkyl and heteroarylalkyl are each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12e) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, each optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12f) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, each substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12g) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12h) R.sup.33 is arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12i) R.sup.33 is benzyl optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl. (12j) R.sup.33 is benzyl substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, or C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl.
(73) Particular embodiments of this aspect of the invention include compounds of any one of the formulae (III), (IIIa), and (IIIb), each as defined in each of the following rows, wherein each entry is a group number as defined above (e.g., (10b) refers to Q is —O—), and a dash “-” indicates that the variable is as defined for formula (III) or defined according to any one of the applicable variable definitions (8a)-(12j) [e.g., when R.sup.1 is a dash, it can be either as defined for Formula (III) or any one of definitions (8a)-(8u)]; and an “x” indicates that the variable is not applicable to the particular embodiment (e.g., when R.sup.3 is (9c), then Q and R.sup.33 are not necessary):
(74) TABLE-US-00003 R.sup.1 R.sup.3 R.sup.33 n & R.sup.32 Q (3)-1 8a 9a 12a — 10b (3)-2 8f 9a 12a — 10b (3)-3 8g 9a 12a — 10b (3)-4 8h 9a 12a — 10b (3)-5 8m 9a 12a — 10b (3)-6 8a 9a 12c — 10b (3)-7 8f 9a 12c — 10b (3)-8 8g 9a 12c — 10b (3)-9 8h 9a 12c — 10b (3)-10 8m 9a 12c — 10b (3)-11 8a 9a 12e — 10b (3)-12 8f 9a 12e — 10b (3)-13 8g 9a 12e — 10b (3)-14 8h 9a 12e — 10b (3)-15 8m 9a 12e — 10b (3)-16 8a 9a 12i — 10b (3)-17 8f 9a 12i — 10b (3)-18 8g 9a 12i — 10b (3)-19 8h 9a 12i — 10b (3)-20 8m 9a 12i — 10b (3)-21 8a 9c x — x (3)-22 8f 9c x — x (3)-23 8g 9c x — x (3)-24 8h 9c x — x (3)-25 8m 9c x — x (3)-26 8a 9d x — x (3)-27 8f 9d x — x (3)-28 8g 9d x — x (3)-29 8h 9d x — x (3)-30 8m 9d x — x (3)-31 8a 9a — — — (3)-32 8f 9a — — — (3)-33 8g 9a — — — (3)-34 8h 9a — — — (3)-35 8m 9a — — — (3)-36 8a 9a — — 10b (3)-37 8f 9a — — 10b (3)-38 8g 9a — — 10b (3)-39 8h 9a — — 10b (3)-40 8m 9a — — 10b (3)-41 — — 12a — 10b (3)-42 — — 12c — 10b (3)-43 — — 12e — 10b (3)-44 — — 12i — 10b (3)-45 — 9a 12a — 10b (3)-46 — 9a 12c — 10b (3)-47 — 9a 12e — 10b (3)-48 — 9a 12i — 10b
(75) Particular embodiments of this aspect of the invention include compounds of any one of the formula (IIIb), each as defined in each of the following rows, wherein each entry is a group number as defined above (e.g., (10b) refers to Q is —O—). In addition, any one of groups (8f)-(8h) can be either as defined for Formula (IIIb) or any one of definitions (8f)-(8u):
(76) TABLE-US-00004 R.sup.1 R.sup.3 R.sup.33 n & R.sup.32 Q (3)-49 8f 9a 12a 11a 10a (3)-50 8g 9a 12a 11a 10a (3)-51 8h 9a 12a 11a 10a (3)-52 8f 9a 12b 11a 10a (3)-53 8g 9a 12b 11a 10a (3)-54 8h 9a 12b 11a 10a (3)-55 8f 9a 12a 11a 10b (3)-56 8g 9a 12a 11a 10b (3)-57 8h 9a 12a 11a 10b (3)-58 8f 9a 12b 11a 10b (3)-59 8g 9a 12b 11a 10b (3)-60 8h 9a 12b 11a 10b (3)-61 8f 9a 12a 11b 10a (3)-62 8g 9a 12a 11b 10a (3)-63 8h 9a 12a 11b 10a (3)-64 8f 9a 12b 11b 10a (3)-65 8g 9a 12b 11b 10a (3)-66 8h 9a 12b 11b 10a (3)-67 8f 9a 12a 11b 10b (3)-68 8g 9a 12a 11b 10b (3)-69 8h 9a 12a 11b 10b (3)-70 8f 9a 12b 11b 10b (3)-71 8g 9a 12b 11b 10b (3)-72 8h 9a 12b 11b 10b
(77) In an embodiment of the preceding embodiments of formulas (I) and (III), the compound is not
(78) ##STR00085##
Methods for Use
(79) Clinical toxoplasmosis is caused by the actively dividing tachyzoite form of the parasite, which exits its host cell and invades a new cell every few days. TgCDPK1 has a unique ATP-binding site with a small gatekeeper residue, as opposed to the large gatekeeper residues present in mammalian protein kinases. This key difference in gatekeeper residues between mammalian kinases and TgCDPK1 allowed us to use bumped kinase inhibitors (BKIs) to selectively inhibit TgCDPK1 without untoward effects on the mammalian host cell.
(80) Accordingly, the disclosure provides methods for treating an apicomplexan protozoan related disease comprising providing to a patient in need of such treatment a therapeutically effective amount of either (i) a bumped kinase inhibitor or (ii) a pharmaceutical composition comprising a bumped kinase inhibitor and a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient, carrier, or diluent.
(81) In one embodiment, the bumped kinase inhibitor is selected from one of the compounds of
(82) In another embodiment, the bumped kinase inhibitor is according to of the formula (I) as defined above, or any embodiment thereof.
(83) In another embodiment, the bumped kinase inhibitor is of the formula (II),
(84) ##STR00086##
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein X, Y, and Z are defined by either: (i) X is N, Y is C, and Z is N; or (ii) X is C, Y is N, and Z is C(H); R.sup.1 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.2-6 alkynyl, —C.sub.1-6 alkyl-R.sup.12, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, or phenyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups; each R.sup.11 is independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R; and R.sup.12 is —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2, phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2; L is a bond or —CH.sub.2—; R.sup.3 is aryl or heteroaryl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups, wherein each R.sup.31 is independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2 or —N(R)S(O).sub.2R, wherein the aryl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, arylalkyl, and heteroarylalkyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.10 groups; each R is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the alkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four R.sup.10 groups;
and each R.sup.10 is independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.0, —SR.sup.0, —N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —C(O)R.sup.0, —C(O)OR.sup.0, —C(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.0, —OC(O)R.sup.0, —OC(O)OR.sup.0, —OC(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, —N(R.sup.0)C(O)R.sup.0, —N(R.sup.0)C(O)OR.sup.0, or —N(R.sup.0)C(O)N(R.sup.0).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.0 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
(85) The disclosure further comprises subgenera of formula (II) in which the substituents are selected as any and all combinations of one or more of structural formula (II), R.sup.1, and R.sup.3, as defined herein, including without limitation, the following:
(86) Structural Formula II is One of Formulae (IIa)-(IIh):
(87) ##STR00087##
R.sup.1 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (6a)-(6ii): (6a) R.sup.1 is C.sub.1-4 alkyl, —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12, C.sub.2-4 alkynyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, or phenyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (6b) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, or phenyl, wherein the cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (6c) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl; or a monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (6d) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl. (6e) R.sup.1 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (6f) R.sup.1 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (6g) R.sup.1 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (6h) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl. (6i) R.sup.1 is C.sub.1-4 alkyl. (6j) R.sup.1 is isopropyl or t-butyl. (6k) R.sup.1 is t-butyl. (6l) R.sup.1 is isopropyl. (6m) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl or —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (6n) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (6o) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-2 alkyl-R.sup.12. (6p) R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12. (6q) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2; (6r) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), R.sup.12 is —C(O)OR or —C(O)NR.sub.2. (6s) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6t) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6u) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), R.sup.12 is phenyl or monocyclic heterocyclyl, each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6v) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6w) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6x) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), R.sup.12 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6y) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6z) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (6aa) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6bb) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A) C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (6cc) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (6dd) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (6ee) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(88) ##STR00088##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (6ff) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(89) ##STR00089##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (6gg) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(90) ##STR00090##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (6hh) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(91) ##STR00091##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (6ii) Any one of groups (6m)-(6p), wherein R.sup.12 is
(92) ##STR00092##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
R.sup.3 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (7a)-(7x): (7a) R.sup.3 is naphthyl, quinolinyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, indolyl, benzodioxolyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzodioxinyl, dibenzothienyl, chromanyl, or phenyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7b) R.sup.3 is naphthyl, quinolinyl, indolyl, benzodioxolyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzodioxinyl, or chromanyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7c) R.sup.3 is quinolinyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, or indolyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7d) R.sup.3 is quinolinyl or indolyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7e) R.sup.3 is quinolinyl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7f) R.sup.3 is pyridyl or pyrimidinyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7g) R.sup.3 is phenyl substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7h) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, or —N(R)S(O).sub.2R. (7i) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is —OR or —N(R)C(O)R. (7j) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.10, wherein R.sup.10 is benzyl optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (7k) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is —N(H)C(O)R.sup.20, wherein R.sup.20 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, aryl, or arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (7l) R.sup.3 is naphthyl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7m) R.sup.3 is naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.15, wherein R.sup.15 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl or benzyl, wherein the benzyl is optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (7n) R.sup.3 is naphth-1-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7o) R.sup.3 is naphth-1-yl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.15, wherein R.sup.15 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl or benzyl, wherein the benzyl is optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (7p) R.sup.3 is naphth-2-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7q) R.sup.3 is naphth-2-yl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.15, wherein R.sup.15 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl or benzyl, wherein the benzyl is optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (7r) R.sup.3 is
(93) ##STR00093## (7s) R.sup.3 is indolyl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7t) R.sup.3 is indol-2-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7u) R.sup.3 is indol-3-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7v) R.sup.3 is indol-5-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7w) R.sup.3 is indol-6-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (7x) Any one of groups (2a)-(2aa) as defined above for formula (I).
(94) Other particular embodiments of this aspect of the invention include compounds of any one of the formulae (II), (IIa)-(IIh), each as defined in each of the following rows, wherein each entry is a group number as defined above (e.g., (7w) refers to R.sup.3 is indol-6-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups), and a dash “-” indicates that the variable is as defined for formula (II) or defined according to any one of the applicable variable definitions (6a)-(7x) [e.g., when R.sup.1 is a dash, it can be either as defined for Formula (II) or any one of definitions (6a)-(6ii)]:
(95) TABLE-US-00005 R.sup.1 R.sup.3 (2)-1 6c 7a (2)-2 6c 7c (2)-3 6c 7e (2)-4 6c 7g (2)-5 6c 7k (2)-6 6c 7l (2)-7 6c 7m (2)-8 6c 7s (2)-9 6c 7t (2)-10 6c 7v (2)-11 6f 7a (2)-12 6f 7c (2)-13 6f 7e (2)-14 6f 7g (2)-15 6f 7k (2)-16 6f 7l (2)-17 6f 7m (2)-18 6f 7s (2)-19 6f 7t (2)-20 6f 7v (2)-21 6h 7a (2)-22 6h 7c (2)-23 6h 7e (2)-24 6h 7g (2)-25 6h 7k (2)-26 6h 7l (2)-27 6h 7m (2)-28 6h 7s (2)-29 6h 7t (2)-30 6h 7v (2)-31 6n 7a (2)-32 6n 7c (2)-33 6n 7e (2)-34 6n 7g (2)-35 6n 7k (2)-36 6n 7l (2)-37 6n 7m (2)-38 6n 7s (2)-39 6n 7t (2)-40 6n 7v (2)-41 6o 7a (2)-42 6o 7c (2)-43 6o 7e (2)-44 6o 7g (2)-45 6o 7k (2)-46 6o 7l (2)-47 6o 7m (2)-48 6o 7s (2)-49 6o 7t (2)-50 6o 7v (2)-51 6p 7a (2)-52 6p 7c (2)-53 6p 7e (2)-54 6p 7g (2)-55 6p 7k (2)-56 6p 7l (2)-57 6p 7m (2)-58 6p 7s (2)-59 6p 7t (2)-60 6p 7v (2)-61 6aa 7a (2)-62 6aa 7c (2)-63 6aa 7e (2)-64 6aa 7g (2)-65 6aa 7k (2)-66 6aa 7l (2)-67 6aa 7m (2)-68 6aa 7s (2)-69 6aa 7t (2)-70 6aa 7v
(96) In another embodiment, the compound of formula (II) is one of compounds of Table B,
(97) TABLE-US-00006 TABLE B Cmpd # Structure Name 1
(98) In another embodiment, the bumped kinase inhibitor is of the formula (IV),
(99) ##STR00218##
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein X, Y, and Z are defined by either: (i) X is N, Y is C, and Z is N; or (ii) X is C, Y is N, and Z is C(H); R.sup.1 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkynyl, —C.sub.1-6 alkyl-R.sup.12, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, monocyclic heterocyclyl, or phenyl, wherein the monocyclic heterocyclyl and phenyl groups are each optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups; each R.sup.11 is independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —C(O)R, or —S(O).sub.2R; and R.sup.12 is —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2;
L is a bond or —CH.sub.2—;
R.sup.3 is aryl or heteroaryl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups, wherein each R.sup.31 is independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, phenyl, benzyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —OC(O)R, —N(R)C(O)R, or —N(R)S(O).sub.2R, wherein the phenyl and benzyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.10 groups;
each R is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl wherein the alkyl, aryl, arylalkyl, heteroaryl, and heteroarylalkyl are optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.10 groups;
and
each R.sup.10 is independently halogen, cyano, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR.sup.0, —SR.sup.0, or —N(R.sup.0).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.0 is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
(100) The disclosure further comprises subgenera of formula (IV) in which the substituents are selected as any and all combinations of one or more of structural formula (IV), R.sup.1, and R.sup.3, as defined herein, including without limitation, the following:
(101) Structural Formula II is one of formulae (IVa)-(IVh):
(102) ##STR00219##
R.sup.1 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (13a)-(13ff): (13a) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl; or a monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (13b) R.sup.1 is C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl. (13c) R.sup.1 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (13d) R.sup.1 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted with one R.sup.11 group. (13e) R.sup.1 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.11 groups. (13f) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl. (13g) R.sup.1 is C.sub.1-4 alkyl. (13h) R.sup.1 is isopropyl or t-butyl. (13i) R.sup.1 is t-butyl. (13j) R.sup.1 is isopropyl. (13k) R.sup.1 is C.sub.2-6 alkyl or —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (131) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-4 alkyl-R.sup.12. (13m) R.sup.1 is —C.sub.1-2 alkyl-R.sup.12. (13n) R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12. (13o) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), R.sup.12 is —C(O)OR or —C(O)NR.sub.2. (13p) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13q) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is phenyl, monocyclic heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, or monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the phenyl, heteroaryl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, and heterocyclyl groups are each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13r) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), R.sup.12 is phenyl or monocyclic heterocyclyl, each optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13s) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one, two, or three groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13t) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is monocyclic heterocyclyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13u) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), R.sup.12 is piperidinyl or tetrahydropyranyl, each optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13v) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently halogen, cyano, nitro, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O) OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13w) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (13x) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13y) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (13z) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (13aa) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is piperidinyl optionally substituted by one or two groups that are each independently C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (13bb) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is
(103) ##STR00220##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R, —OC(O)R, —OC(O)OR, —OC(O)NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, —N(R)C(O)OR, or —N(R)C(O)NR.sub.2. (13cc) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is
(104) ##STR00221##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, C.sub.3-8 cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (13dd) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is
(105) ##STR00222##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, —C(O)OR.sup.A, —C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, —OC(O)R.sup.A, —OC(O)OR.sup.A, —OC(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)R.sup.A, —N(R.sup.A)C(O)OR.sup.A, or —N(R.sup.A)C(O)N(R.sup.A).sub.2, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl. (13ee) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is
(106) ##STR00223##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R, —C(O)OR, —C(O)NR.sub.2, or —S(O).sub.2R. (13ff) Any one of groups (13k)-(13n), wherein R.sup.12 is
(107) ##STR00224##
wherein R.sup.B is hydrogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —C(O)R.sup.A, or —S(O).sub.2R.sup.A, wherein each R.sup.A is independently hydrogen or C.sub.1-6 alkyl.
R.sup.3 is Selected from One of the Following Groups (14a)-(14x): (14a) R.sup.3 is naphthyl, quinolinyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, indolyl, benzodioxolyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzodioxinyl, dibenzothienyl, chromanyl, or phenyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14b) R.sup.3 is naphthyl, quinolinyl, indolyl, benzodioxolyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzodioxinyl, or chromanyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14c) R.sup.3 is quinolinyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, or indolyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14d) R.sup.3 is quinolinyl or indolyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14e) R.sup.3 is quinolinyl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14f) R.sup.3 is pyridyl or pyrimidinyl, each optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14g) R.sup.3 is phenyl substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14h) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, —OR, —SR, —NR.sub.2, —N(R)C(O)R, or —N(R)S(O).sub.2R. (14i) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is —OR or —N(R)C(O)R. (14j) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.10, wherein R.sup.10 is benzyl optionally substituted with one, two, three, or four groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (14k) R.sup.3 is phenyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups, and substituted with one group that is —N(H)C(O)R.sup.20, wherein R.sup.20 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.2-6 alkenyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, aryl, or arylC.sub.1-6 alkyl. (14l) R.sup.3 is naphthyl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14m) R.sup.3 is naphthyl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.15, wherein R.sup.15 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl or benzyl, wherein the benzyl is optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (14n) R.sup.3 is naphth-1-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14o) R.sup.3 is naphth-1-yl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.15, wherein R.sup.15 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl or benzyl, wherein the benzyl is optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (14p) R.sup.3 is naphth-2-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14q) R.sup.3 is naphth-2-yl optionally substituted with one or two R.sup.31 groups and substituted with one group that is —OR.sup.15, wherein R.sup.15 is C.sub.1-6 alkyl or benzyl, wherein the benzyl is optionally substituted with one or two groups that are each independently halogen, C.sub.1-6 alkyl, C.sub.1-6 haloalkyl, or —OR.sup.0. (14r) R.sup.3 is
(108) ##STR00225## (14s) R.sup.3 is indolyl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14t) R.sup.3 is indol-2-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14u) R.sup.3 is indol-3-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14v) R.sup.3 is indol-5-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14w) R.sup.3 is indol-6-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups. (14x) Any one of groups (2a)-(2aa) as defined above for formula (I).
(109) Other particular embodiments of this aspect of the invention include compounds of any one of the formulae (IV), (IVa)-(IVh), each as defined in each of the following rows, wherein each entry is a group number as defined above (e.g., (14w) refers to R.sup.3 is indol-6-yl optionally substituted with one, two, or three R.sup.31 groups), and a dash “-” indicates that the variable is as defined for formula (IV) or defined according to any one of the applicable variable definitions (13a)-(14x) [e.g., when R.sup.1 is a dash, it can be either as defined for Formula (IV) or any one of definitions (13a)-(13ff)]:
(110) TABLE-US-00007 R.sup.1 R.sup.3 (4)-1 13a 14b (4)-2 13a 14d (4)-3 13a 14e (4)-4 13a 14g (4)-5 13a 14i (4)-6 13a 14k (4)-7 13a 14m (4)-8 13a 14q (4)-9 13a 14t (4)-10 13a 14v (4)-11 13f 14b (4)-12 13f 14d (4)-13 13f 14e (4)-14 13f 14g (4)-15 13f 14i (4)-16 13f 14k (4)-17 13f 14m (4)-18 13f 14q (4)-19 13f 14t (4)-20 13f 14v (4)-21 13l 14b (4)-22 13l 14d (4)-23 13l 14e (4)-24 13l 14g (4)-25 13l 14i (4)-26 13l 14k (4)-27 13l 14m (4)-28 13l 14q (4)-29 13l 14t (4)-30 13l 14v (4)-31 13v 14b (4)-32 13v 14d (4)-33 13v 14e (4)-34 13v 14g (4)-35 13v 14i (4)-36 13v 14k (4)-37 13v 14m (4)-38 13v 14q (4)-39 13v 14t (4)-40 13v 14v (4)-41 13bb 14b (4)-42 13bb 14d (4)-43 13bb 14e (4)-44 13bb 14g (4)-45 13bb 14i (4)-46 13bb 14k (4)-47 13bb 14m (4)-48 13bb 14q (4)-49 13bb 14t (4)-50 13bb 14v
(111) Particular embodiments of this aspect of the invention include compounds of any one of the formula (IVb) or (IVh), each as defined in each of the following rows, wherein each entry is a group number as defined above (e.g., (13n) refers to R.sup.1 is —CH.sub.2—R.sup.12). In addition, any one of groups (13k)-(13n) can be either as defined for Formula (IV) or any one of definitions (13p)-(13ff):
(112) TABLE-US-00008 R.sup.1 R.sup.3 (4)-51 13k 14a (4)-52 13k 14b (4)-53 13k 14l (4)-54 13k 14m (4)-55 13k 14p (4)-56 13k 14q (4)-57 13k 14r (4)-58 13l 14a (4)-59 13l 14b (4)-60 13l 14l (4)-61 13l 14m (4)-62 13l 14p (4)-63 13l 14q (4)-64 13l 14r (4)-65 13m 14a (4)-66 13m 14b (4)-67 13m 14l (4)-68 13m 14m (4)-69 13m 14p (4)-70 13m 14q (4)-71 13m 14r (4)-72 13n 14a (4)-73 13n 14b (4)-74 13n 14l (4)-1 13n 14m (4)-2 13n 14p (4)-3 13n 14q (4)-1 13n 14r
(113) In an embodiment of any of the preceding, the compound of formula (II) and (IV) is not one of the following compounds
(114) ##STR00226## ##STR00227##
(115) One embodiment of the present disclosure provide a method of treating a subject in need of treatment for an apicomplexan-related disease comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of any of formulas (I)-(IV) or any embodiment thereof, that inhibits the activity of an apicomplexan calcium dependent protein kinase (CDPK).
(116) Particular embodiments of the present disclosure provide a method of treating cryptosporidiosis in a subject comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of any of formulas (I)-(IV) or any embodiment thereof, that inhibits the activity of Cryptosporidium parvum and C. hominus calcium dependent protein kinase 1 (CpCDPK1).
(117) Other particular embodiments of the present disclosure provide a method of treating cryptosporidiosis in a subject comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of any of formulas (I)-(IV) or any embodiment thereof, that inhibits the activity of T. gondii, calcium dependent protein kinase 1 (TgCDPK1).
(118) Other particular embodiments of the present disclosure provide a method of treating cryptosporidiosis in a subject comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of any of formulas (I)-(IV) or any embodiment thereof, that inhibits the activity of P. falciparum or P. berghei calcium dependent protein kinase 4 (PfCDPK4 or PbCDPK4).
(119) Optionally, the compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) or any embodiment thereof, can be administered in combination with a second agent, such as agents specific for use against the specific apicomplexan-related disorder being treated.
(120) In one embodiment, the apicomplexan protozoan related disease is toxoplasmosis. As understood by one of ordinary skill in the art, toxoplasmosis can encompass a number of pathologies, including, but not limited to, encephalitis, retinitis, lymphadenopathy, disseminated disease, and hepatitis. Toxoplasmosis infects most genera of warm-blooded animals, including humans, but the primary host is the felid (cat) family.
(121) Cats are the definitive host for the Toxoplasma organism. Infection with this protozoan parasite is fairly common, but actual disease caused by this parasite is relatively rare in cats. Cats can become infected by Toxoplasma by eating any of the three infective stages of the parasites. The most common route of infection is probably by ingestion of tissue cysts in infected prey or in other raw meat. Toxoplasma multiply in the small intestines and in approximately two to three weeks the oocysts are excreted in the infected cat's feces. In another example, cats may be treated prophylactically for toxoplasmosis (e.g, a gastrointestinal infection) provided by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compounds of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) or to eliminate the chance that they would shed infectious Toxoplasmodia oocyts and infect their owners. In another embodiment, infected cats may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat toxoplasmosis. As will be understood by those of skill in the art, similar prophylactic and therapeutic methods for limiting development of or treating toxoplasmosis can be used in any animal that can be infected by Toxoplasma sp.
(122) Animals are infected by eating infected meat, by ingestion of feces of a cat that has itself recently been infected, or by transmission from mother to fetus. While cats are often blamed for spreading toxoplasmosis, contact with raw meat is a more significant source of human infections in many countries, and fecal contamination of hands is a greater risk factor. Infection has two stages (1) acute toxoplasmosis; and (2) latent toxoplasmosis. During acute toxoplasmosis, symptoms are often influenza-like: swollen lymph nodes, or muscle aches and pains that last for a month or more. Rarely, a patient with a fully functioning immune system may develop eye damage from toxoplasmosis. Young children (15 years old or younger) and immunocompromised patients, such as those with HIV/AIDS, those taking certain types of chemotherapy, or those who have recently received an organ transplant, may develop severe toxoplasmosis. In an embodiment, a young child can be 14 years old or younger; or 13 years old or younger; or 12 years old or younger; or 11 years old or younger; or 10 years old or younger; or 9 years old or younger; or 8 years old or younger; or 7 years old or younger; or 6 years old or younger; or 5 years old or younger; or 4 years old or younger; or 3 years old or younger; or 2 years old or younger; or 1 year old or younger. This can cause damage to the brain (encephalitis) or the eyes (necrotizing retinochoroiditis). Infants infected via placental transmission may be born with either of these problems, or with nasal malformations, although these complications are rare in newborns. In most immunocompetent patients, the infection enters a latent phase, during which only bradyzoites are present, forming cysts in nervous and muscle tissue. Most infants who are infected while in the womb have no symptoms at birth but may develop symptoms later in life. The most common current therapy for toxoplasmosis is sulfadiazine/pyrimethamine combination therapy, but therapy is often limited by allergic reactions to the sulfa component, anemia and pancytopenia induced by blocking the folate pathway. When sulfadiazine cannot be used, clindamycin may be combined with pyrimethamine but most experts feel it does not work as well as sulfadiazine. Spiramycin has been used for toxoplasmosis during pregnancy but has issues with low efficacy and is no longer available in the United States. Thus few therapeutic alternatives are available.
(123) In another embodiment, the apicomplexan protozoan related disease is cryptosporidiosis. Cryptosporidiosis is caused by infection with the single-celled parasite (not bacterium) Cryptosporidium parvum. This parasite is found in many mammals including lambs, calves, goat kids, piglets and humans. Research so far has shown two basic types, the bovine type which affects most species, and a second human type which causes disease in humans only. Outbreaks of human disease, where large numbers of people are affected, are usually water-borne and usually associated with the bovine type of cryptosporidium. Individual sporadic cases of cryptosporidiosis in humans are mostly (around 60%) associated with the human type of cryptosporidium.
(124) Cryptosporidiosis affects the intestines of mammals and is typically an acute short-term infection. It is spread through the fecal-oral route, often through contaminated water; the main symptom is self-limiting diarrhea in people with intact immune systems. In immunocompromised individuals, such as HIV/AIDS patients, the symptoms are particularly severe and often fatal. Cryptosporidium is the organism most commonly isolated in HIV positive patients presenting with diarrhea. Cryptosporidiosis is one of the most common waterborne diseases and is found worldwide. The parasite is transmitted by environmentally hardy microbial cysts (oocysts) that, once ingested, exist in the small intestine and result in an infection of intestinal epithelial tissue. Infection is through contaminated material such as earth, water, uncooked or cross-contaminated food that has been in contact with the feces of an infected individual or animal. It is especially prevalent amongst those in regular contact with bodies of fresh water including recreational water such as swimming pools. Other potential sources include insufficiently treated or insufficiently filtered water supplies, contaminated food, or exposure to feces. Symptoms appear from two to ten days after infection, and last for up to two weeks or more. In immunocompetent people, the disease can be asymptomatic or cause acute diarrhea or persistent diarrhea that can last for a few weeks. There is often stomach pain or cramping and a low fever. Other symptoms may include nausea, vomiting, malabsorption, and dehydration. Individuals who are asymptomatic (have no symptoms) are nevertheless infective. Immunocompromised people, as well as very young or very old people, can develop a more severe form of cryptosporidiosis. When Cryptosporidium spreads beyond the intestine, as it can predominantly in patients with AIDS, it can reach the lungs, middle ear, pancreas, and stomach. Thus, one symptom is pain in the right upper quadrant. The parasite can infect the biliary tract, causing biliary cryptosporidiosis. This can result in cholecystitis and cholangitis. Current treatment is symptomatic, with fluid rehydration, electrolyte correction and management of any pain. Nitazoxanide has been FDA-approved for treatment of diarrhea caused by Cryptosporidium in people with healthy immune systems and is available by prescription, however it only shortens the duration of diarrhea by a couple of days. The effectiveness of nitazoxanide in immunosuppressed individuals is unclear and multiple trials have shown no benefit.
(125) The inhibitors described herein may have use in other apicoplexa protozoan related diseases, such as coccidiosis caused by Eimeria spp., cause infections and disease in poultry; which causes Babesiosis which is caused by Babesia spp. and results in a malaria-like disease, and malaria in humans and animals caused by Plasmodium spp.
(126) Plasmodium calcium dependent protein kinase 4 (CDPK4) is essential for exflaggelation of microgametes, sexual reproduction and infection of the mosquito host and is a potential drug target to block mosquito transmission. Plasmodium transmission-blocking compounds that act via inhibition of PfCDPK4 have great promise in the armamentarium of malaria control. Plasmodium CDPK4 has a unique ATP binding site which renders CDPK4 differentially sensitive to bumped kinase inhibitors (BKIs). TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 have ATP-binding pockets with an atypically small gatekeeper residue, glycine. P. falciparum CDPK4 (PfCDPK4) has a serine residue at the gatekeeper position, smaller than any gatekeeper in mammalian kinases, and an overall ATP-binding pocket that is very similar to TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1. BKIs inhibit P. falciparum CDPK4 (PfCDPK4) and prevents the exflagellation of malaria microgametes. Administration of BKIs to mice stops the transmission of P. berghei to mosquitoes. Finally, addition of BKIs to blood containing P. falciparum gametocytes stops exflagellation of microgametocytes and blocks the infection of mosquitoes. BKIs are non-toxic, selective inhibitors that block malaria transmission to mosquitos, have favorable oral pharmacokinetic (PK) properties, have a low likelihood of generating resistance.
(127) Thus, other particular embodiments of the present disclosure provide a method for treating malaria comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of any of formulas (I)-(IV) or any embodiment thereof, that inhibits the activity of Plasmodium falciparum and P. berghei calcium dependent protein kinases. In one embodiment, the compound can be administered in combination with a second agent. In another embodiment, the subject has malaria, and the second agent is an anti-malarial therapeutic. The subject can be human. In further embodiments, the subject is a mammal other than a human, such as a cat or livestock (e.g., pigs, sheep, goats, cattle).
(128) As used herein, the term “subject”, “individual,” or “patient,” used interchangeably, refers to any animal, including mammals, preferably mice, rats, other rodents, rabbits, dogs, cats, birds, swine, horses, livestock (e.g., pigs, sheep, goats, cattle), primates or humans.
(129) As used here, a subject “in need thereof” refers to a subject that has the disorder or disease to be treated or is predisposed to or otherwise at risk of developing the disease or disorder.
(130) As used here, the terms “treatment” and “treating” means (i) inhibiting the progression of the disease; (ii) prophylactic use for example, preventing or limiting development of a disease, condition or disorder in an individual who may be predisposed or otherwise at risk to the disease, condition or disorder but does not yet experience or display the pathology or symptomatology of the disease; (iii) inhibiting the disease; for example, inhibiting a disease, condition or disorder in an individual who is experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease, condition or disorder; (iv) Ameliorating the referenced disease state, for example, ameliorating a disease, condition or disorder in an individual who is experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease, condition or disorder (i.e., reversing or improving the pathology and/or symptomatology) such as decreasing the severity of disease; (v) eliciting the referenced biological effect, or (vi) limiting transmission of the disease.
(131) In various preferred embodiments, the individual may be immunocompromised (having an immune system that has been impaired by disease or treatment, such as an HIV infected patient, and AIDS patient, or a patient receiving chemotherapy or an organ transplant), a pregnant female, fifteen years old or younger, fifty-five years old or older, exposed to contaminated water supplies, and/or exposed to other sources of contamination (fecal matter, blood transfusion, earth, food, etc.) The methods may further comprise administering the compounds disclosed herein to subjects at risk of acquiring an apicomplexan-related disease, such as those with compromised immune systems or that are extremely young in high risk areas.
(132) In other embodiments, the compounds described herein can be used in prophylactic manner. Cryptosporidiosis is usually seen in calves between one and two weeks of age and presents with diarrhea, colic and pain, depression, loss of appetite, and weight loss. Thus, in one embodiment, calves may be treated prophylactically by providing an effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or transmission of cryptosporidiosis. In a preferred embodiment, the administering is done within the first 7-8 days after birth (day 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8) when calves are most susceptible to Cryptosporidia infection. Such treatments may be repeated as necessary as would be understood by one skilled in the art.
(133) In another embodiment, infected cattle may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat cryptosporidiosis. Such treatments may be repeated as necessary as would be understood by one skilled in the art. In this embodiment, the compounds of the invention may be administered together with electrolytes if cattle become dehydrated. If disease is severe, halfuginone can be used in combination with the compounds of the invention to reduce disease severity and prevent spread to other animals.
(134) In another example, lambs are susceptible to cryptosporidiosis and may be provided a therapeutically effective amount of a compounds of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or transmission of cryptosporidiosis.
(135) In another example, any or all members of a herd (e.g., cattle, goats, lambs, etc.), may be provided a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or transmission of toxoplasmosis or cryptosporidiosis or to rid the herd of cattle of toxoplasmosis or cryptosporidiosis.
(136) In another embodiment, goat kids may be treated prophylactically by providing an effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or transmission of cryptosporidiosis. In a preferred embodiment, the administering is done within the first 7-8 days after birth (day 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8) when kids are most susceptible to cryptosporidiosis. Such treatments may be repeated as necessary as would be understood by one skilled in the art. The extent to which a kid is infected seems to be dependent on its age and immune status. Younger animals are much more susceptible to infection than adults. In studies done with lambs, five-day-old lambs had diarrhea for 9-10 days and suffered from a high rate of mortality. Sixty-day-old lambs showed no symptoms when they were infected, and adult sheep completely resisted infection. There is an indication that adults develop an immunity to Cryptosporidium, yet this immunity does not seem to be passed to their offspring.
(137) Immune-depressed goats are very susceptible to the disease. This refers to the total immune status, not just protection from cryptosporidiosis. Many situations can cause animals to lack immunity. Animals with severe infections are more susceptible to secondary infections. The most common problem with kids is receiving a deficient amount of colostral antibodies following birth. Whether caused by disease, an imbalanced ration or improper management, animals lacking adequate immunity are much more susceptible to cryptosporidiosis.
(138) In another embodiment, infected goats may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat cryptosporidiosis. In a preferred embodiment, the goat is a kid.
(139) In another example, pigs are susceptible to cryptosporidiosis and may be provided a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or transmission of cryptosporidiosis. In a preferred embodiment, the administering is done within the first 21 days after birth (day 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, or 21) when piglets are most susceptible to cryptosporidiosis and/or most likely
(140) In another embodiment, infected pigs may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat cryptosporidiosis. In a preferred embodiment, the pig is a piglet.
(141) In another example, birds, such as turkeys and chickens, are susceptible to cryptosporidiosis and may be provided an effective amount of a compounds of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to prevent the contraction or transmission of cryptosporidiosis. In particular, Cryptosporidium baileyi can cause respiratory disease in chickens and turkeys. The same species causes infections of the hindgut and cloacal bursa in chickens, turkeys, and ducks. C. meleagridis also infects both species. A further species causes respiratory disease in quail. The oocysts are excreted ready sporulated in the faeces and infection occurs by inhalation and ingestion. Signs of cryptosporidiosis in poultry include snick, cough, swollen sinuses, low weight gain, and diarrhea. In another embodiment, infected birds may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat cryptosporidiosis.
(142) In another example, birds, such as turkeys and chickens, are susceptible to coccidiosis due to Eimeria infections and may be provided an effective amount of a compounds of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or transmission of coccidiosis, a parasitic disease caused by the development and multiplication of coccidia in the epithelial cells of the intestine. Eimeria infections are ubiquitous; they are found wherever chickens or turkeys are reared (traditional, industrial, label or organic/bio farms). Particular strains of Eimeria known to infect birds include, but are not limited to, Eimeria acervulina. Eimeria adenoeides, Eimeria brunette, Eimeria colchici, Eimeria curvata, Eimeria dispersa, Eimeria duodenali, Eimeria fraterculae, Eimeria gallopavonis, Eimeria praecox, Eimeria maxima, Eimeria meleagrimitis, Eimeria mitis, Eimeria necatrix, Eimeria phasiani, Eimeria procera, and Eimeria tenella. In another embodiment, infected birds may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat coccidiosis In another example, mammals, such as goats, sheep, llamas, alpacas, cattle, rabbits, and mice, are susceptible to coccidiosis and may be provided an effective amount of a compounds of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to limit the contraction or spreading of Eimeria. Particular strains of Eimeria known to infect mammals include, but are not limited to, Eimeria ahsata, Eimeria alabamensis, Eimeria alijevi, Eimeria apsheronica, Eimeria arloingi, Eimeria arundeli, Eimeria bakuensis, Eimeria bovis, Eimeria cameli, Eimeria caprina, Eimeria caprovina, Eimeria christenseni, Eimeria clethrionomyis, Eimeria coecicola, Eimeria contorta, Eimeria couesii, Eimeria crandallis, Eimeria dammahensis, Eimeria dowleri, Eimeria exigua, Eimeria falciformis, Eimeria farasanii, Eimeria ferrisi, Eimeria flavescens, Eimeria gallatii, Eimeria granulosa, Eimeria hirci, Eimeria intestinalis, Eimeria irresidua, Eimeria intricata, Eimeria jolchijevi, Eimeria krijgsmanni, Eimeria larimerensis, Eimeria macusaniensis, Eimeria magna, Eimeria marconii, Eimeria media, Eimeria melanuri, Eimeria myoxi, Eimeria nagpurensis, Eimeria ninakohlyakimovae, Eimeria ovinoidalis, Eimeria pallida, Eimeria palustris, Eimeria papillata, Eimeria perforans, Eimeria phocae, Eimeria pileata, Eimeria pipistrellu, Eimeria piriformis, Eimeria prionotemni, Eimeria punctate, Eimeria roobroucki, Eimeria saudiensis, Eimeria sealanderi, Eimeria separate, Eimeria stiedae, Eimeria ursini, Eimeria vermiformis, Eimeria weybridgensis, Eimeria wobati, and Eimeria zuernii. In another embodiment, infected mammals may be treated by providing a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of any one of formulas (I)-(IV) to treat coccidiosis
(143) The usual age range for animals suffering from coccidiosis is from three weeks to one year of age, but cattle remain susceptible to coccidiosis throughout their lives or until they develop acquired immunity. The susceptibility of the animals is influenced by nutritional status (colostrum supply), stress (overstocking, transport, climate, hygiene, etc.), immune status and the occurrence of concurrent diseases.
(144) Infections with multiple Eimeria species (pathogenic and non-pathogenic) are common in real life situations. The most important species related to the clinical manifestation of the disease in the stable are Eimeria bovis and Eimeria zuernii, although other pathogenic coccidia species may also affect the cattle in the stables, such as Eimeria alabamensis (animals fed on contaminated hay), which is commonly associated with diarrheic problems in animals that are released to pasture.
(145) “Carrier hosts” shed relatively fewer oocysts and the susceptible “multiplier hosts” pick up the infection and shed many-fold oocysts into the environment. Exposure to multiplier hosts leads to subclinical or mildly clinical infection in animals exposed to a large number of oocysts in the environment. Calves exposed to a large number of oocysts are likely to develop severe coccidiosis. In feedlots where few oocysts are present, stress factors such as weaning, diet, temperature extremes and other variables may make the calves more susceptible to infection and under such conditions the reproductive potential of coccidia in the gut greatly increases.
(146) In goats, although the infection can occur in any goat herd raised under semi and intensive management practices, it is most frequently observed in kids 2 to 4 weeks postweaning. The infection occurs by ingesting the pathogenic sporulated oocyst (sporulated is a form of resistance of the Coccidia). Oocysts can be found in the water or in feed supplies contaminated with feces. Once ingested, oocysts penetrate the cells lining the intestine where they go through several stages of development and cause inflammation and destruction of intestinal cells. Stress is the predisposing factor in kids during the postweaning period. Outbreaks can occur during stressful conditions such as after shipping or when animals are relocated. Outbreaks can also occur during sudden weather changes, after a change in concentrated feed practices, when animals are recovering from a disease, or in worm burden cases. Although coccidiosis can occur year around, a higher incidence occurs during postweaning.
(147) The compounds disclosed herein can be used to treat coccidiosis in combination with standard treatments such as, but not limited to, replacing fluids by administering liquid nutritional supplement orally by nipple bottle until the animal is rehydrated. Animals that have lost 5 percent of their body weight may require intravenous (IV) and/or electrolyte therapy. Treatment may include IV or subcutaneously (SC) fluid therapy with a physiologically balanced electrolyte such as Ringer's, Plasmalyte-A, or Normosol-R. Administer the solution (2 to 5 milliliters per pound) one to three times daily until the animal is rehydrated. Sulfas such as Albon™, Sulmet™, or Di-Methox™, can also be mixed in the drinking water or as a drench for individual goats. An alternative is CORID™ (amprolium).
(148) As used herein, the phrase “therapeutically effective amount” refers to the amount of active compound or pharmaceutical agent that elicits the biological or medicinal response that is being sought in a tissue, system, animal, individual or human by a researcher, veterinarian, medical doctor or other clinician, which includes one or more of the following: (1) preventing the disease; for example, preventing a disease, condition or disorder in an individual who may be predisposed to the disease, condition or disorder but does not yet experience or display the pathology or symptomatology of the disease; (2) inhibiting the disease; for example, inhibiting a disease, condition or disorder in an individual who is experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease, condition or disorder; and (3) ameliorating the disease; for example, ameliorating a disease, condition or disorder in an individual who is experiencing or displaying the pathology or symptomatology of the disease, condition or disorder (i.e., reversing the pathology and/or symptomatology) such as decreasing the severity of disease.
Methods for Identifying a Compound
(149) As disclosed herein, the inventors have identified compounds for use in treating apicomplexan-related disorders. While not being bound by a specific mechanism of action, the inventors believe that the inhibitory activity is based on selective inhibition of apicomplexan protein kinases, specifically selective inhibitors against apicomplexan calcium-dependent protein kinases (CDPKs). The inventors have further identified a specific region of such CDPKs that the inhibitors bind to, exemplified by SEQ ID NO:1 (from the T. gondii, CDPK (SEQ ID NO: 13); (TgCDPK))) and SEQ ID NO:2 (from the C. parvum CDPK (CpCDPK)(SEQ ID NOs: 14, 15, 16, 17)). Thus, another aspect of the present disclosure provides a method of identifying a compound for treating an apicomplexan-related disease, including but not limited to those disclosed above, and most preferably toxoplasmosis and cryptosporidiosis. The method comprises (a) contacting a polypeptide comprising an amino acid sequence according to SEQ ID NO. 1 or SEQ ID NO:2 with a compound to be tested for the ability to bind to the polypeptide under conditions suitable for binding to the polypeptide, and (b) identifying compounds that bind to the polypeptide. Suitable conditions for such binding can be determined by one of skill in the art based on the teachings herein. For example, the methods may comprise suitable wash steps to remove unbound compounds. The methods may be conducted in vitro, or the binding may be assayed in cells using appropriate reporter molecules.
(150) In one embodiment, the method comprises contacting the compound with the recited peptide. In another embodiment, the compound is contacted with TgCDPK or CpCDPK. In a further embodiment, the compound is contacted with TgCDPK or CpCDPK under conditions for crystallizing the complex, as described in the examples that follow. In all of these embodiments, the method may further comprise comparing binding of the compound to a control. Any suitable control can be used. In one embodiment, the control comprises comparing binding of the polypeptide to binding of the compound to a control polypeptide. Any suitable control polypeptide may be used. In one embodiment, the control polypeptide may comprise a mutated CDPK active region, such as TgCDPK1 G128M (described below), or corresponding C. parvum CDPK mutated at the gatekeeper glycine residue (CpCDPK residue 150) (as described in detail herein). For example, the gatekeeper glycine residue in any TgCDPK or CpCDPK may be mutated as described herein to replace the glycine residue with alanine, arginine, asparagine, aspartic acid, cysteine, glutamic acid, glutamine, histidine, isoleucine, leucine, lysine, methionine, phenylalanine, proline, serine, threonine, tryptophan, tyrosine, or valine. In these embodiments, those compounds that show selective binding to the polypeptide and little to no binding to the control peptide are identified as selective inhibitors against apicomplexan CDPKs. Exemplary methods according to this aspect of the invention are described in the examples that follow.
(151) In a further embodiment, the methods may comprise a verification step (c), comprising applying a compound selected in (b) to the relevant apicomplexan species, such Toxoplasma gondii of C. parvum, to test for inhibitory activity. Exemplary such assays for inhibitory activity are described in the examples herein.
(152) When the test compounds comprise polypeptide sequences, such polypeptides may be chemically synthesized or recombinantly expressed. Recombinant expression can be accomplished using standard methods in the art, as disclosed above. Such expression vectors can comprise bacterial or viral expression vectors, and such host cells can be prokaryotic or eukaryotic. Synthetic polypeptides, prepared using the well-known techniques of solid phase, liquid phase, or peptide condensation techniques, or any combination thereof, can include natural and unnatural amino acids. Amino acids used for peptide synthesis may be standard Boc (Nα-amino protected Nu-t-butyloxycarbonyl) amino acid resin with standard deprotecting, neutralization, coupling and wash protocols, or standard base-labile Nα-amino protected 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl (Fmoc) amino acids. Both Fmoc and Boc Nα-amino protected amino acids can be obtained from Sigma, Cambridge Research Biochemical, or other chemical companies familiar to those skilled in the art. In addition, the polypeptides can be synthesized with other Nα-protecting groups that are familiar to those skilled in this art. Solid phase peptide synthesis may be accomplished by techniques familiar to those in the art and provided, such as by using automated synthesizers.
(153) When the test compounds comprise antibodies, such antibodies can be polyclonal or monoclonal. The antibodies can be humanized, fully human, or murine forms of the antibodies. Such antibodies can be made by well-known methods, such as described in Harlow and Lane, Antibodies; A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (1988).
(154) When the test compounds comprise nucleic acid sequences, such nucleic acids may be chemically synthesized or recombinantly expressed as well. Recombinant expression techniques are well known to those in the art (See, for example, Sambrook, et al., 1989, supra). The nucleic acids may be DNA or RNA, and may be single stranded or double. Similarly, such nucleic acids can be chemically or enzymatically synthesized by manual or automated reactions, using standard techniques in the art. If synthesized chemically or by in vitro enzymatic synthesis, the nucleic acid may be purified prior to introduction into the cell. For example, the nucleic acids can be purified from a mixture by extraction with a solvent or resin, precipitation, electrophoresis, chromatography, or a combination thereof. Alternatively, the nucleic acids may be used with no or a minimum of purification to avoid losses due to sample processing.
(155) When the test compounds comprise compounds other than polypeptides, antibodies, or nucleic acids, such compounds can be made by any of the variety of methods in the art for conducting organic chemical synthesis.
Pharmaceutical Compositions
(156) The pharmaceutical compositions described herein generally comprise a combination of a compound described herein and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, or excipient. Such compositions are substantially free of non-pharmaceutically acceptable components, i.e., contain amounts of non-pharmaceutically acceptable components lower than permitted by US regulatory requirements at the time of filing this application. In some embodiments of this aspect, if the compound is dissolved or suspended in water, the composition further optionally comprises an additional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, or excipient. In other embodiments, the pharmaceutical compositions described herein are solid pharmaceutical compositions (e.g., tablet, capsules, etc.).
(157) These compositions can be prepared in a manner well known in the pharmaceutical art, and can be administered by a variety of routes, depending upon whether local or systemic treatment is desired and upon the area to be treated. Administration may be topical (including ophthalmic and to mucous membranes including intranasal, vaginal and rectal delivery), pulmonary (e.g., by inhalation or insufflation of powders or aerosols, including by nebulizer; intratracheal, intranasal, epidermal and transdermal), ocular, oral or parenteral. Methods for ocular delivery can include topical administration (eye drops), subconjunctival, periocular or intravitreal injection or introduction by balloon catheter or ophthalmic inserts surgically placed in the conjunctival sac. Parenteral administration includes intravenous, intraarterial, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal or intramuscular injection or infusion; or intracranial, e.g., intrathecal or intraventricular, administration. Parenteral administration can be in the form of a single bolus dose, or may be, for example, by a continuous perfusion pump. Pharmaceutical compositions and formulations for topical administration may include transdermal patches, ointments, lotions, creams, gels, drops, suppositories, sprays, liquids and powders. Conventional pharmaceutical carriers, aqueous, powder or oily bases, thickeners and the like may be necessary or desirable.
(158) Also, pharmaceutical compositions can contain, as the active ingredient, one or more of the compounds described herein above in combination with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. In making the compositions described herein, the active ingredient is typically mixed with an excipient, diluted by an excipient or enclosed within such a carrier in the form of, for example, a capsule, sachet, paper, or other container. When the excipient serves as a diluent, it can be a solid, semi-solid, or liquid material, which acts as a vehicle, carrier or medium for the active ingredient. Thus, the compositions can be in the form of tablets, pills, powders, lozenges, sachets, cachets, elixirs, suspensions, emulsions, solutions, syrups, aerosols (as a solid or in a liquid medium), ointments containing, for example, up to 10% by weight of the active compound, soft and hard gelatin capsules, suppositories, sterile injectable solutions, and sterile packaged powders.
(159) In preparing a formulation, the active compound can be milled to provide the appropriate particle size prior to combining with the other ingredients. If the active compound is substantially insoluble, it can be milled to a particle size of less than 200 mesh. If the active compound is substantially water soluble, the particle size can be adjusted by milling to provide a substantially uniform distribution in the formulation, e.g. about 40 mesh.
(160) Some examples of suitable excipients include lactose, dextrose, sucrose, sorbitol, mannitol, starches, gum acacia, calcium phosphate, alginates, tragacanth, gelatin, calcium silicate, microcrystalline cellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone, cellulose, water, syrup, and methyl cellulose. The formulations can additionally include: lubricating agents such as talc, magnesium stearate, and mineral oil; wetting agents; emulsifying and suspending agents; preserving agents such as methyl- and propylhydroxy-benzoates; sweetening agents; and flavoring agents. The compositions described herein can be formulated so as to provide quick, sustained or delayed release of the active ingredient after administration to the patient by employing procedures known in the art.
(161) The compositions can be formulated in a unit dosage form, each dosage containing from about 5 to about 100 mg, more usually about 10 to about 30 mg, of the active ingredient. The term “unit dosage forms” refers to physically discrete units suitable as unitary dosages for human subjects and other mammals, each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active material calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect, in association with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient.
(162) The active compound can be effective over a wide dosage range and is generally administered in a pharmaceutically effective amount. It will be understood, however, that the amount of the compound actually administered will usually be determined by a physician, according to the relevant circumstances, including the condition to be treated, the chosen route of administration, the actual compound administered, the age, weight, and response of the individual patient, the severity of the patient's symptoms, and the like.
(163) For preparing solid compositions such as tablets, the principal active ingredient is mixed with a pharmaceutical excipient to form a solid preformulation composition containing a homogeneous mixture of a compound described herein. When referring to these preformulation compositions as homogeneous, the active ingredient is typically dispersed evenly throughout the composition so that the composition can be readily subdivided into equally effective unit dosage forms such as tablets, pills and capsules. This solid preformulation is then subdivided into unit dosage forms of the type described above containing from, for example, 0.1 to about 500 mg of the active ingredient of a compound described herein.
(164) The tablets or pills can be coated or otherwise compounded to provide a dosage form affording the advantage of prolonged action. For example, the tablet or pill can comprise an inner dosage and an outer dosage component, the latter being in the form of an envelope over the former. The two components can be separated by an enteric layer which serves to resist disintegration in the stomach and permit the inner component to pass intact into the duodenum or to be delayed in release. A variety of materials can be used for such enteric layers or coatings, such materials including a number of polymeric acids and mixtures of polymeric acids with such materials as shellac, cetyl alcohol, and cellulose acetate.
(165) The liquid forms in which the compounds and compositions can be incorporated for administration orally or by injection include aqueous solutions, suitably flavored syrups, aqueous or oil suspensions, and flavored emulsions with edible oils such as cottonseed oil, sesame oil, coconut oil, or peanut oil, as well as elixirs and similar pharmaceutical vehicles.
(166) Compositions for inhalation or insufflation include solutions and suspensions in pharmaceutically acceptable, aqueous or organic solvents, or mixtures thereof, and powders. The liquid or solid compositions may contain suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients as described supra. In some embodiments, the compositions are administered by the oral or nasal respiratory route for local or systemic effect. Compositions in can be nebulized by use of inert gases. Nebulized solutions may be breathed directly from the nebulizing device or the nebulizing device can be attached to a face masks tent, or intermittent positive pressure breathing machine. Solution, suspension, or powder compositions can be administered orally or nasally from devices which deliver the formulation in an appropriate manner.
(167) The amount of compound or composition administered to a patient will vary depending upon what is being administered, the purpose of the administration, such as prophylaxis or therapy, the state of the patient, the manner of administration, and the like. In therapeutic applications, compositions can be administered to a patient already suffering from a disease in an amount sufficient to cure or at least partially arrest the symptoms of the disease and its complications. Effective doses will depend on the disease condition being treated as well as by the judgment of the attending clinician depending upon factors such as the severity of the disease, the age, weight and general condition of the patient, and the like.
(168) The compositions administered to a patient can be in the form of pharmaceutical compositions described above. These compositions can be sterilized by conventional sterilization techniques, or may be sterile filtered. Aqueous solutions can be packaged for use as is, or lyophilized, the lyophilized preparation being combined with a sterile aqueous carrier prior to administration. The pH of the compound preparations typically will be between 3 and 11, more preferably from 5 to 9 and most preferably from 7 to 8. It will be understood that use of certain of the foregoing excipients, carriers, or stabilizers will result in the formation of pharmaceutical salts.
(169) The therapeutic dosage of the compounds can vary according to, for example, the particular use for which the treatment is made, the manner of administration of the compound, the health and condition of the patient, and the judgment of the prescribing physician. The proportion or concentration of a compound described herein in a pharmaceutical composition can vary depending upon a number of factors including dosage, chemical characteristics (e.g., hydrophobicity), and the route of administration. For example, the compounds described herein can be provided in an aqueous physiological buffer solution containing about 0.1 to about 10% w/v of the compound for parenteral administration. Some typical dose ranges are from about 1 μg/kg to about 1 g/kg of body weight per day. In some embodiments, the dose range is from about 0.01 mg/kg to about 100 mg/kg of body weight per day. The dosage is likely to depend on such variables as the type and extent of progression of the disease or disorder, the overall health status of the particular patient, the relative biological efficacy of the compound selected, formulation of the excipient, and its route of administration. Effective doses can be extrapolated from dose-response curves derived from in vitro or animal model test systems.
(170) The compounds described herein can also be formulated in combination with one or more additional active ingredients which can include any pharmaceutical agent such as anti-viral agents, vaccines, antibodies, immune enhancers, immune suppressants, anti-inflammatory agents and the like.
Definitions
(171) Unless the context clearly requires otherwise, throughout the description and the claims, the words ‘comprise’, ‘comprising’, and the like are to be construed in an inclusive sense as opposed to an exclusive or exhaustive sense; that is to say, in the sense of “including, but not limited to”. Words using the singular or plural number also include the plural or singular number, respectively. Additionally, the words “herein,” “above” and “below” and words of similar import, when used in this application, shall refer to this application as a whole and not to any particular portions of this application.
(172) Terms used herein may be preceded and/or followed by a single dash, “-”, or a double dash, “=”, to indicate the bond order of the bond between the named substituent and its parent moiety; a single dash indicates a single bond and a double dash indicates a double bond. In the absence of a single or double dash it is understood that a single bond is formed between the substituent and its parent moiety; further, substituents are intended to be read “left to right” unless a dash indicates otherwise. For example, C.sub.1-C.sub.6alkoxycarbonyloxy and —OC(O)C.sub.1-C.sub.6alkyl indicate the same functionality; similarly arylalkyl and -alkylaryl indicate the same functionality.
(173) The term “alkenyl” as used herein, means a straight or branched chain hydrocarbon containing from 2 to 10 carbons, unless otherwise specified, and containing at least one carbon-carbon double bond. Representative examples of alkenyl include, but are not limited to, ethenyl, 2-propenyl, 2-methyl-2-propenyl, 3-butenyl, 4-pentenyl, 5-hexenyl, 2-heptenyl, 2-methyl-1-heptenyl, 3-decenyl, and 3,7-dimethylocta-2,6-dienyl.
(174) The term “alkyl” as used herein, means a straight or branched chain hydrocarbon containing from 1 to 10 carbon atoms, unless otherwise specified. Representative examples of alkyl include, but are not limited to, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, sec-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl, n-pentyl, isopentyl, neopentyl, n-hexyl, 3-methylhexyl, 2,2-dimethylpentyl, 2,3-dimethylpentyl, n-heptyl, n-octyl, n-nonyl, and n-decyl. When an “alkyl” group is a linking group between two other moieties, then it may also be a straight or branched chain; examples include, but are not limited to —CH.sub.2—, —CH.sub.2CH.sub.2—, —CH.sub.2CH.sub.2CHC(CH.sub.3)—, —CH.sub.2CH(CH.sub.2CH.sub.3)CH.sub.2—.
(175) The term “alkynyl” as used herein, means a straight or branched chain hydrocarbon group containing from 2 to 10 carbon atoms and containing at least one carbon-carbon triple bond. Representative examples of alkynyl include, but are not limited, to acetylenyl, 1-propynyl, 2-propynyl, 3-butynyl, 2-pentynyl, and 1-butynyl.
(176) The term “aryl,” as used herein, means a phenyl (i.e., monocyclic aryl), a bicyclic ring system containing at least one phenyl ring or an aromatic bicyclic ring containing only carbon atoms in the aromatic bicyclic ring system or a multicyclic aryl ring system, provided that the bicyclic or multicyclic aryl ring system does not contain a heteroaryl ring when fully aromatic. The bicyclic aryl can be azulenyl, naphthyl, or a phenyl fused to a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, or a monocyclic heterocyclyl. The bicyclic aryl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom contained within the phenyl portion of the bicyclic system, or any carbon atom with the napthyl or azulenyl ring. The fused monocyclic cycloalkyl or monocyclic heterocyclyl portions of the bicyclic aryl are optionally substituted with one or two oxo and/or thia groups. Representative examples of the bicyclic aryls include, but are not limited to, azulenyl, naphthyl, dihydroinden-1-yl, dihydroinden-2-yl, dihydroinden-3-yl, dihydroinden-4-yl, 2,3-dihydroindol-4-yl, 2,3-dihydroindol-5-yl, 2,3-dihydroindol-6-yl, 2,3-dihydroindol-7-yl, inden-1-yl, inden-2-yl, inden-3-yl, inden-4-yl, dihydronaphthalen-2-yl, dihydronaphthalen-3-yl, dihydronaphthalen-4-yl, dihydronaphthalen-1-yl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydronaphthalen-1-yl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydronaphthalen-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuran-4-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuran-5-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuran-6-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuran-7-yl, benzo[d][1,3]dioxol-4-yl, benzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl, 2H-chromen-2-On-5-yl, 2H-chromen-2-On-6-yl, 2H-chromen-2-On-7-yl, 2H-chromen-2-On-8-yl, isoindoline-1,3-dion-4-yl, isoindoline-1,3-dion-5-yl, inden-1-On-4-yl, inden-1-On-5-yl, inden-1-On-6-yl, inden-1-On-7-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzo[b][1,4]dioxan-5-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzo[b][1,4]dioxan-6-yl, 2H-benzol[b][1,4]oxazin3(4H)-On-5-yl, 2H-benzol[b][1,4]oxazin3(4H)-On-6-yl, 2H-benzol[b][1,4]oxazin3(4H)-On-7-yl, 2H-benzol[b][1,4]oxazin3(4H)-On-8-yl, benzol[d]oxazin-2(3H)-On-5-yl, benzol[d]oxazin-2(3H)-On-6-yl, benzo[d]oxazin-2(3H)-On-7-yl, benzo[d]oxazin-2(3H)-On-8-yl, quinazolin-4(3H)-On-5-yl, quinazolin-4(3H)-On-6-yl, quinazolin-4(3H)-On-7-yl, quinazolin-4(3H)-On-8-yl, quinoxalin-2(1H)-On-5-yl, quinoxalin-2(1H)-On-6-yl, quinoxalin-2(1H)-On-7-yl, quinoxalin-2(1H)-On-8-yl, benzo[d]thiazol-2(3H)-On-4-yl, benzo[d]thiazol-2(3H)-On-5-yl, benzo[d]thiazol-2(3H)-On-6-yl, and, benzo[d]thiazol-2(3H)-On-7-yl. In certain embodiments, the bicyclic aryl is (i) naphthyl or (ii) a phenyl ring fused to either a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkenyl, or a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heterocyclyl, wherein the fused cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, and heterocyclyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. Multicyclic aryl groups are a phenyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two other ring systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a bicyclic aryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic or bicyclic heterocyclyl, provided that when the base ring is fused to a bicyclic cycloalkyl, bicyclic cycloalkenyl, or bicyclic heterocyclyl, then the base ring is fused to the base ring of the a bicyclic cycloalkyl, bicyclic cycloalkenyl, or bicyclic heterocyclyl. The multicyclic aryl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom contained within the base ring. In certain embodiments, multicyclic aryl groups are a phenyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two other ring systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic heterocyclyl, provided that when the base ring is fused to a bicyclic cycloalkyl, bicyclic cycloalkenyl, or bicyclic heterocyclyl, then the base ring is fused to the base ring of the a bicyclic cycloalkyl, bicyclic cycloalkenyl, or bicyclic heterocyclyl. Examples of multicyclic aryl groups include but are not limited to anthracen-9-yl and phenanthren-9-yl.
(177) The term “arylalkyl” and “-alkylaryl” as used herein, means an aryl group, as defined herein, appended to the parent molecular moiety through an alkyl group, as defined herein. Representative examples of arylalkyl include, but are not limited to, benzyl, 2-phenylethyl, 3-phenylpropyl, and 2-naphth-2-ylethyl.
(178) The terms “cyano” and “nitrile” as used herein, mean a —CN group.
(179) The term “cycloalkyl” as used herein, means a monocyclic, bicyclic, or a multicyclic cycloalkyl ring system. Monocyclic ring systems are cyclic hydrocarbon groups containing from 3 to 8 carbon atoms, where such groups can be saturated or unsaturated, but not aromatic. In certain embodiments, cycloalkyl groups are fully saturated. Examples of monocyclic cycloalkyls include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopentenyl, cyclohexyl, cyclohexenyl, cycloheptyl, and cyclooctyl. Bicyclic cycloalkyl ring systems are bridged monocyclic rings or fused bicyclic rings. Bridged monocyclic rings contain a monocyclic cycloalkyl ring where two non-adjacent carbon atoms of the monocyclic ring are linked by an alkylene bridge of between one and three additional carbon atoms (i.e., a bridging group of the form —(CH.sub.2).sub.w—, where w is 1, 2, or 3). Representative examples of bicyclic ring systems include, but are not limited to, bicyclo[3.1.1]heptane, bicyclo[2.2.1]heptane, bicyclo[2.2.2]octane, bicyclo[3.2.2]nonane, bicyclo[3.3.1]nonane, and bicyclo[4.2.1]nonane. Fused bicyclic cycloalkyl ring systems contain a monocyclic cycloalkyl ring fused to either a phenyl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a monocyclic heterocyclyl, or a monocyclic heteroaryl. The bridged or fused bicyclic cycloalkyl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom contained within the monocyclic cycloalkyl ring. Cycloalkyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. In certain embodiments, the fused bicyclic cycloalkyl is a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkyl ring fused to either a phenyl ring, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heterocyclyl, or a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heteroaryl, wherein the fused bicyclic cycloalkyl is optionally substituted by one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. Multicyclic cycloalkyl ring systems are a monocyclic cycloalkyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two other rings systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a bicyclic aryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic or bicyclic heterocyclyl. The multicyclic cycloalkyl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom contained within the base ring. In certain embodiments, multicyclic cycloalkyl ring systems are a monocyclic cycloalkyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two other rings systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a monocyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic heterocyclyl. Examples of multicyclic cycloalkyl groups include, but are not limited to tetradecahydrophenanthrenyl, perhydrophenothiazin-1-yl, and perhydrophenoxazin-1-yl.
(180) “Cycloalkenyl” as used herein refers to a monocyclic, bicyclic, or a multicyclic cycloalkenyl ring system. Monocyclic ring systems are cyclic hydrocarbon groups containing from 3 to 8 carbon atoms, where such groups are unsaturated (i.e., containing at least one annular carbon-carbon double bond), but not aromatic. Examples of monocyclic ring systems include cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl. Bicyclic cycloalkenyl rings are bridged monocyclic rings or a fused bicyclic rings. Bridged monocyclic rings contain a monocyclic cycloalkenyl ring where two non-adjacent carbon atoms of the monocyclic ring are linked by an alkylene bridge of between one and three additional carbon atoms (i.e., a bridging group of the form —(CH.sub.2).sub.w—, where w is 1, 2, or 3). Representative examples of bicyclic cycloalkenyls include, but are not limited to, norbornenyl and bicyclo[2.2.2]oct-2-enyl. Fused bicyclic cycloalkenyl ring systems contain a monocyclic cycloalkenyl ring fused to either a phenyl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a monocyclic heterocyclyl, or a monocyclic heteroaryl. The bridged or fused bicyclic cycloalkenyl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom contained within the monocyclic cycloalkenyl ring. Cycloalkenyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. Multicyclic cycloalkenyl rings contain a monocyclic cycloalkenyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two rings systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a bicyclic aryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic or bicyclic heterocyclyl. The multicyclic cycloalkenyl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom contained within the base ring. IN certain embodiments, multicyclic cycloalkenyl rings contain a monocyclic cycloalkenyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two rings systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a monocyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic heterocyclyl.
(181) The term “halo” or “halogen” as used herein, means —Cl, —Br, —I or —F.
(182) The term “haloalkyl” as used herein, means at least one halogen, as defined herein, appended to the parent molecular moiety through an alkyl group, as defined herein. Representative examples of haloalkyl include, but are not limited to, chloromethyl, 2-fluoroethyl, trifluoromethyl, pentafluoroethyl, and 2-chloro-3-fluoropentyl.
(183) The term “heteroaryl,” as used herein, means a monocyclic, bicyclic, or a multicyclic heteroaryl ring system. The monocyclic heteroaryl can be a 5 or 6 membered ring. The 5 membered ring consists of two double bonds and one, two, three or four nitrogen atoms and optionally one oxygen or sulfur atom. The 6 membered ring consists of three double bonds and one, two, three or four nitrogen atoms. The 5 or 6 membered heteroaryl is connected to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom or any nitrogen atom contained within the heteroaryl. Representative examples of monocyclic heteroaryl include, but are not limited to, furyl, imidazolyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, oxadiazolyl, oxazolyl, pyridinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl, pyrrolyl, tetrazolyl, thiadiazolyl, thiazolyl, thienyl, triazolyl, and triazinyl. The bicyclic heteroaryl consists of a monocyclic heteroaryl fused to a phenyl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a monocyclic heterocyclyl, or a monocyclic heteroaryl. The fused cycloalkyl or heterocyclyl portion of the bicyclic heteroaryl group is optionally substituted with one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. When the bicyclic heteroaryl contains a fused cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, or heterocyclyl ring, then the bicyclic heteroaryl group is connected to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon or nitrogen atom contained within the monocyclic heteroaryl portion of the bicyclic ring system. When the bicyclic heteroaryl is a monocyclic heteroaryl fused to a phenyl ring or a monocyclic heteroaryl, then the bicyclic heteroaryl group is connected to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom or nitrogen atom within the bicyclic ring system. Representative examples of bicyclic heteroaryl include, but are not limited to, benzimidazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzothienyl, benzoxadiazolyl, benzoxathiadiazolyl, benzothiazolyl, cinnolinyl, 5,6-dihydroquinolin-2-yl, 5,6-dihydroisoquinolin-1-yl, furopyridinyl, indazolyl, indolyl, isoquinolinyl, naphthyridinyl, quinolinyl, purinyl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroquinolin-2-yl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroquinolin-3-yl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroquinolin-4-yl, 5,6,7,8-tetrahydroisoquinolin-1-yl, thienopyridinyl, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydrobenzo[c][1,2,5]oxadiazolyl, and 6,7-dihydrobenzo[c][1,2,5]oxadiazol-4(5H)-onyl. In certain embodiments, the fused bicyclic heteroaryl is a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heteroaryl ring fused to either a phenyl ring, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heterocyclyl, or a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heteroaryl, wherein the fused cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, and heterocyclyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. The multicyclic heteroaryl group is a monocyclic heteroaryl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic heterocyclyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic cycloalkyl; or (ii) two ring systems selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a bicyclic aryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic heterocyclyl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkyl. The multicyclic heteroaryl group is connected to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom or nitrogen atom contained within the base ring. In certain embodiments, multicyclic heteroaryl groups are a monocyclic heteroaryl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic heterocyclyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic cycloalkyl; or (ii) two ring systems selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a monocyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic heterocyclyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic cycloalkyl. Examples of multicyclic heteroaryls include, but are not limited to 5H-[1,2,4]triazino[5,6-b]indol-5-yl, 2,3,4,9-tetrahydro-1H-carbazol-9-yl, 9H-pyrido[3,4-b]indol-9-yl, 9H-carbazol-9-yl, acridin-9-yl,
(184) The term “heteroarylalkyl” and “-alkylheteroaryl” as used herein, means a heteroaryl, as defined herein, appended to the parent molecular moiety through an alkyl group, as defined herein. Representative examples of heteroarylalkyl include, but are not limited to, fur-3-ylmethyl, 1H-imidazol-2-ylmethyl, 1H-imidazol-4-ylmethyl, 1-(pyridin-4-yl)ethyl, pyridin-3-ylmethyl, pyridin-4-ylmethyl, pyrimidin-5-ylmethyl, 2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)propyl, thien-2-ylmethyl, and thien-3-ylmethyl.
(185) The term “heterocyclyl” as used herein, means a monocyclic, bicyclic, or multicyclic heterocycle. The monocyclic heterocycle is a 3, 4, 5, 6 or 7 membered ring containing at least one heteroatom independently selected from the group consisting of O, N, and S where the ring is saturated or unsaturated, but not aromatic. The 3 or 4 membered ring contains 1 heteroatom selected from the group consisting of O, N and S. The 5 membered ring can contain zero or one double bond and one, two or three heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, N and S. The 6 or 7 membered ring contains zero, one or two double bonds and one, two or three heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, N and S. The monocyclic heterocycle is connected to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom or any nitrogen atom contained within the monocyclic heterocycle. Representative examples of monocyclic heterocycle include, but are not limited to, azetidinyl, azepanyl, aziridinyl, diazepanyl, 1,3-dioxanyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, 1,3-dithiolanyl, 1,3-dithianyl, imidazolinyl, imidazolidinyl, isothiazolinyl, isothiazolidinyl, isoxazolinyl, isoxazolidinyl, morpholinyl, oxadiazolinyl, oxadiazolidinyl, oxazolinyl, oxazolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidinyl, pyranyl, pyrazolinyl, pyrazolidinyl, pyrrolinyl, pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothienyl, thiadiazolinyl, thiadiazolidinyl, thiazolinyl, thiazolidinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxidothiomorpholinyl (thiomorpholine sulfone), thiopyranyl, and trithianyl. The bicyclic heterocycle is a monocyclic heterocycle fused to either a phenyl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a monocyclic heterocycle, or a monocyclic heteroaryl. The bicyclic heterocycle is connected to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom or any nitrogen atom contained within the monocyclic heterocycle portion of the bicyclic ring system. Representative examples of bicyclic heterocyclyls include, but are not limited to, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuran-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuran-3-yl, indolin-1-yl, indolin-2-yl, indolin-3-yl, 2,3-dihydrobenzothien-2-yl, decahydroquinolinyl, decahydroisoquinolinyl, octahydro-1H-indolyl, and octahydrobenzofuranyl. Heterocyclyl groups are optionally substituted with one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. In certain embodiments, the bicyclic heterocyclyl is a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heterocyclyl ring fused to phenyl ring, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic cycloalkenyl, a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heterocyclyl, or a 5 or 6 membered monocyclic heteroaryl, wherein the bicyclic heterocyclyl is optionally substituted by one or two groups which are independently oxo or thia. Multicyclic heterocyclyl ring systems are a monocyclic heterocyclyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two other rings systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a bicyclic aryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic or bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic or bicyclic heterocyclyl. The multicyclic heterocyclyl is attached to the parent molecular moiety through any carbon atom or nitrogen atom contained within the base ring. In certain embodiments, multicyclic heterocyclyl ring systems are a monocyclic heterocyclyl ring (base ring) fused to either (i) one ring system selected from the group consisting of a bicyclic aryl, a bicyclic heteroaryl, a bicyclic cycloalkyl, a bicyclic cycloalkenyl, and a bicyclic heterocyclyl; or (ii) two other rings systems independently selected from the group consisting of a phenyl, a monocyclic heteroaryl, a monocyclic cycloalkyl, a monocyclic cycloalkenyl, and a monocyclic heterocyclyl. Examples of multicyclic heterocyclyl groups include, but are not limited to 10H-phenothiazin-10-yl, 9,10-dihydroacridin-9-yl, 9,10-dihydroacridin-10-yl, 10H-phenoxazin-10-yl, 10,11-dihydro-5H-dibenzo[b,f]azepin-5-yl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydropyrido[4,3-g]isoquinolin-2-yl, 12H-benzo[b]phenoxazin-12-yl, and dodecahydro-1H-carbazol-9-yl.
(186) The term “nitro” as used herein, means a —NO.sub.2 group.
(187) The term “oxo” as used herein means a ═O group.
(188) The term “saturated” as used herein means the referenced chemical structure does not contain any multiple carbon-carbon bonds. For example, a saturated cycloalkyl group as defined herein includes cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, and the like.
(189) The term “thia” as used herein means a ═S group.
(190) The term “unsaturated” as used herein means the referenced chemical structure contains at least one multiple carbon-carbon bond, but is not aromatic. For example, a unsaturated cycloalkyl group as defined herein includes cyclohexenyl, cyclopentenyl, cyclohexadienyl, and the like.
(191) As used herein, the phrase “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” refers to both pharmaceutically acceptable acid and base addition salts and solvates. Such pharmaceutically acceptable salts include salts of acids such as hydrochloric, phosphoric, hydrobromic, sulfuric, sulfinic, formic, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic, nitric, benzoic, citric, tartaric, maleic, hydroiodic, alkanoic such as acetic, HOOC—(CH.sub.2).sub.n—COOH where n is 0-4, and the like. Non-toxic pharmaceutical base addition salts include salts of bases such as sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, and the like. Those skilled in the art will recognize a wide variety of non-toxic pharmaceutically acceptable addition salts.
Synthetic Methods
(192) The two exemplary synthetic routes described below can be used to generate derivatives that contain varying substituents at the 1- and 3-positions of the pyrazolopyrimidine core (Schemes 1 and 2). The first series of analogs retain the naphthylmethylene substituent at the 3-position and contain various alkyl groups at the 1-position. Synthesis of these analogs began with conversion of 1-naphthalene acetyl chloride to pyrazolopyrimidine 4 in five steps (Scheme 1). (16)
(193) ##STR00228##
(194) To introduce various alkyl substituents at the 1-position, 4 can be derivatized with alkyl halides by direct nucleophilic displacement (5a-5e) or with alcohols using standard Mitsunobu reaction conditions (5a-5e). (17,18) Notably, the use of support-bound triphenylphosphine for the Mitsunobu reaction can expedite the purification of alkylated products. (19) The N-Boc protecting groups can be removed from piperidine analogues 5f-5h and the resultant free amines can be acetylated, sulfonylated, or alkylated.
(195) The second series of derivatives can be generated with a synthetic route that allows various substituents to be introduced at the 3-position of the pyrazolopyrimidine core (Scheme 2).
(196) ##STR00229##
(197) Iodinated pyrazolopyrimidine 6 can be generated in three steps from commercially available 5-amino-1H-pyrazole-4-carbonitrile. Various aryl substituents can be introduced by coupling boronic acids and boronic esters to 6 using standard palladium-catalyzed cross-coupling conditions.
SYNTHETIC EXAMPLES
(198) Commercially available reagents and anhydrous solvents were used without further purification unless otherwise specified. The final purity of all compounds was determined by analytical HPLC with an Agilent ZORBAX SB-C18 column (2.1 mm×150 mm). Analytical HPLC data were generated by injecting 20 μL of sample solution in methanol and acetonitrile to a reverse phase HPLC system run over 30 min (2-100% acetonitrile/water with 0.05% TFA and 2-100% methanol/water with 0.05% TFA). The products were detected by UV at the detection frequency of 254 nm. All compounds were determined to be >95% pure by this method. Flash chromatography was performed on prepacked columns of silica gel (Varian SF10-4g, Si 50) by IntelliFlash with EtOAc/hexanes or MeOH/CH.sub.2Cl.sub.2 as eluent. The purification by preparative HPLC was performed on Varian Dynamax Microsorb 100-5 C18 column (250 mm×21.4 mm) with CH.sub.3CN/H.sub.2O or MeOH/H.sub.2O and 0.05% TFA as eluent. The mass spectra were recorded with the Bruker Esquire Liquid Chromatograph—Ion Trap Mass Spectrometer. NMR spectra were recorded with either a Bruker 300 MHz spectrometer or Bruker 500 MHz spectrometer at ambient temperature with the residual solvent peaks as internal standards. The chemical shifts are given in ppm (δ) and coupling constants are reported in Hz. .sup.1H resonances are referenced to CDCl.sub.3 (7.26 ppm), DMSO-d.sub.6 (2.54) or CD.sub.3OD (3.34).
Example 1 Preparation of Intermediate A
(199) ##STR00230##
(200) To malononitrile (0.646 g, 9.8 mmol) in THF (15 mL) and sodium hydride (0.494 g, 19.5 mmol, 95% dispersion in paraffin oil), 1-naphthyleneacetyl chloride (2.0 g, 9.8 mmol) was added dropwise at 5-10° C. After 3 h, the reaction mixture was warmed to room temperature and hydrochloric acid (45 mL) was added. The mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate (3×75 mL) and the organic layer was dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4 to yield A (1.71 g, 75%). .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 7.96-8.02 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.91 (m, 2H), 7.49-7.59 (m, 2H), 7.41-7.47 (m, 2H), 4.12 (s, 2H), 3.56 (s, 1H).
Example 2 Preparation of Intermediate B
(201) ##STR00231##
(202) To sodium hydrogen carbonate (6.112 g, 72.7 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane (12 mL) and water (2 mL), compound A (2.130 g, 9.1 mmol) and dimethyl sulfate (6.038 mL, 63.6 mmol) were added slowly. After stirring at 85° C. for 2.5 h, water (60 mL) was added. Extraction with tert-butyl methyl ether (4×50 mL), drying of the organic layer with Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, and silica gel chromatography using an ethyl acetate-hexanes gradient yielded B (0.964 g, 43%). .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.08-8.13 (m, 1H), 7.99-8.03 (m, 1H), 7.92-7.97 (m, 1H), 7.58-7.70 (m, 2H), 7.49-7.56 (m, 1H), 7.25-7.30 (m, 1H), 4.63 (s, 2H), 3.98 (s, 3H).
Example 3 Preparation of Compound 4
(203) ##STR00232##
(204) To compound B (0.908 g, 3.66 mmol) in ethanol (10 mL), hydrazine hydrate (222 μL, 3.66 mmol, 80% hydrazine hydrate) and triethylamine (501 μL, 3.66 mmol) were added. After refluxing for 3.5 h the solvent was evaporated and water was added. The solid was collected and without any further purification, was refluxed in formamide (6 mL) overnight. The cold reaction mixture was diluted with water and the precipitate was collected. This precipitate was redissolved in chloroform and then purified by silica gel chromatography using a methanol-chloroform gradient to yield 4 (456 mg, 45%). 1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.37 (s, 1H), 8.05-8.14 (m, 1H), 7.89-7.97 (m, 1H), 7.78-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.38-7.57 (m, 4H), 4.86 (s, 2H).
Example 4 General Procedure A
(205) ##STR00233##
(206) A mixture of 4 (0.073 mmol), K.sub.2CO.sub.3 (4.0 equiv), and the appropriate alkyl halide (1.1 equiv) were dissolved in dimethylformamide (400 μL) and acetonitrile (1 mL). The reaction was heated to 5° C. below the boiling point of the alkyl halide overnight. Preparative HPLC with a methanol/water gradient was used to yield the final compound.
Example 5 Preparation of Compound 3
(207) 3 was synthesized using isopropyl iodide as the alkyl halide in General Procedure A. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.04 (s, 1H), 7.98-8.03 (m, 1H), 7.84-7.92 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.56 (m, 3H), 7.30-7.36 (m, 1H), 5.14 (sept, J=6.9, 1H), 4.76 (s, 2H), 1.62 (d, J=6.9, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=318.4.
Example 6 Preparation of Compound 5a
(208) 5a was synthesized using methyl iodide as the alkyl halide in General Procedure A. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.90-8.02 (m, 3H), 7.46-7.61 (m, 3H), 7.36-7.42 (m, 1H), 4.79 (s, 2H), 4.14 (s, 3H). (M+H).sup.+=290.4.
Example 7 Preparation of Compound 5b
(209) 5b was synthesized using propargyl bromide as the alkyl halide in General Procedure A. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.12 (s, 1H), 7.95-8.00 (m, 1H), 7.87-7.92 (m, 2H), 7.46-7.55 (m, 3H), 7.36-7.40 (m, 1H), 5.24 (m, 2H), 4.79 (s, 2H), 2.48 (m, 1H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=314.4.
Example 8 Preparation of Compound 5c
(210) 5c was synthesized using iodoacetamide as the alkyl halide in General Procedure A. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 500 MHz) δ 8.31 (s, 1H), 8.08-8.11 (m, 1H), 7.88-7.92 (s, 1H), 7.81-7.84 (m, 1H), 7.50-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.41-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.26-7.30 (m, 1H), 5.06 (s, 2H), 4.79 (s, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=333.4.
Example 9 Preparation of Compound 5e
(211) 5e was synthesized using benzyl bromide as the alkyl halide in General Procedure A. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.12-8.16 (m, 2H), 7.88-7.94 (m, 2H), 7.74-7.80 (m, 1H), 7.61-7.65 (m, 2H), 7.40 (m, 5H), 5.65 (s, 2H) 4.79 (s, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=366.5.
Example 10 Preparation of Compound 5f
(212) 5f was synthesized using cyclohexyl iodide as the alkyl halide in General Procedure A. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.18-8.23 (m, 1H), 8.16 (s, 1H), 7.88-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.78-7.83 (m, 1H), 7.49-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.36-7.43 (m, 1H), 7.16-7.21 (m, 1H), 4.79 (s, 2H), 4.18-4.24 (m, 1H), 3.66-3.71 (m, 2H), 3.53-3.58 (m, 2H), 1.92-1.99 (m, 2H), 1.35-1.40 (m, 2H), 0.86-0.94 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=358.5.
Example 11 General Procedure B
(213) ##STR00234##
(214) A mixture of 4 (0.073 mmol), polymer-supported triphenylphosphine (2 equiv of 1.52 mmol/g PL-TPP from Varian Polymer Laboratories) and the appropriate alcohol (1.0 equiv) were dissolved in dry THF (1 mL) and stirred under N2. Diethyl azodicarboxylate (1.5 equiv) was then added at 0° C. After 15 min, the reaction mixture was warmed to room temperature and allowed to run overnight. The resin was filtered off and washed with dicholoromethane, concentrated in vacuo, and purified using reverse-phase preparative HPLC with a methanol/water gradient. The desired product was collected and subsequently deprotected by stirring in a mixture of trifluoroactetic acid (0.5 mL) and dicholoromethane (0.5 mL) for 2 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo to yield the final compound.
Example 12 Preparation of Compound 5g
(215) 5g was synthesized using N-boc piperidine-4-ol as the alcohol in General Procedure B. .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.33 (s, 1H), 8.15-8.20 (m, 1H), 7.91-7.96 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.84 (m, 1H), 7.51-7.57 (m, 2H), 7.37-7.44 (m, 1H), 7.19-7.23 (m, 1H), 4.95 (m, 1H), 4.84 (s, 2H), 3.32-3.41 (m, 2H), 3.05-3.20 (m, 2H), 2.11-2.26 (m, 2H), 1.95-2.05 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=359.4.
Example 13 Preparation of Compound 5h
(216) 5h was synthesized using N-boc piperidine-4-methanol as the alcohol in General Procedure B. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 500 MHz) δ 8.12 (s, 1H), 8.04-8.09 (m, 1H), 7.93-7.97 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.85 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.52 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.44 (m, 1H), 7.29-7.32 (m, 1H), 4.75 (s, 2H), 4.16 (d, J=7.0, 2H), 2.83-2.90 (m, 2H), 2.17-2.24 (m, 1H), 1.70-1.76 (m, 2H), 1.36-1.47 (m, 2H), 0.84-0.97 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=373.5.
Example 14 Preparation of Compound 5i
(217) 5i was synthesized using N-boc piperidine-4-ethanol as the alcohol in General Procedure B. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.25 (s, 1H), 7.98-8.02 (m, 1H), 7.86-7.90 (m, 1H), 7.78-7.82 (m, 1H), 7.44-7.49 (m, 2H), 7.38-7.42 (m, 1H), 7.28-7.32 (m, 1H), 4.81 (s, 2H), 4.30-4.35 (m, 2H), 3.57-3.62 (m, 2H), 2.50-2.61 (m, 2H), 1.90-2.01 (m, 2H), 1.75-1.85 (m, 5H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=387.5.
Example 15 General Procedure C
(218) ##STR00235##
(219) Acetic anhydride (1 equiv) and diisopropylethylamine (3 equiv) were added to compounds 5g-5i (0.028 mmol) and dissolved in dimethylformamide (200 μL). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with methanol and water and purified using reverse-phase preparative HPLC with a methanol/water gradient.
Example 16 Preparation of Compound 5j
(220) 5j was synthesized using 5g in General Procedure C. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.09 (s, 1H), 7.88-8.00 (m, 3H), 7.44-7.58 (m, 3H), 7.34-7.39 (m, 1H), 4.95-5.05 (m, 1H), 4.81-4.90 (m, 1H), 4.76 (s, 2H), 4.04-4.13 (m, 1H), 3.29-3.41 (m, 1H), 2.81-2.91 (m, 1H), 2.06-2.40 (m, 7H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=401.5.
Example 17 Preparation of Compound 5k
(221) 5k was synthesized using 5h in General Procedure C. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.25 (s, 1H), 8.04-8.10 (m, 1H), 7.88-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.85 (m, 1H), 7.47-7.52 (m, 2H), 7.39-7.45 (m, 1H), 7.29-7.33 (m, 1H), 4.78 (s, 2H), 4.38-4.46 (m, 1H), 4.24 (d, J=6.9, 2H), 3.79-3.87 (m, 1H), 2.95-3.05 (m, 1H), 2.45-2.58 (m, 1H), 2.10-2.20 (m, 1H), 2.05 (s, 3H), 1.46-1.60 (m, 2H), 1.32-1.40 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=415.5.
Example 18 Preparation of Compound 5l
(222) 5l was synthesized using Si in General Procedure C. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.05-8.11 (m, 1H), 7.89-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.82-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.41-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.30-7.34 (m, 1H), 4.82 (s, 2H), 4.33-4.40 (m, 2H), 3.72-3.77 (m, 1H), 3.43-3.49 (m, 1H), 2.71-2.79 (m, 1H), 2.26-2.33 (m, 1H), 2.04 (s, 3H), 1.72-1.79 (m, 2H), 1.60-1.70 (m, 2H), 1.32-1.42 (m, 3H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=429.5.
Example 19 General Procedure D
(223) ##STR00236##
(224) Acetaldehyde (10 equiv), sodium triacetoxyborohydride (3 equiv), diisopropylethylamine (0.75 equiv), and a catalytic amount of acetic acid were added to 5g-5i (0.028 mmol) and dissolved in dichloroethane (200 μL). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with methanol and water and purified using reverse-phase preparative HPLC with a methanol/water gradient.
Example 20 Preparation of Compound 5m
(225) 5m was synthesized using 5g in General Procedure D. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.22 (s, 1H), 8.08-8.14 (m, 1H), 7.87-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.85 (m, 1H), 7.49-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.42-7.47 (m, 1H), 7.31-7.35 (m, 1H), 4.89-4.96 (m, 1H), 4.80 (s, 2H), 4.32-4.38 (m, 2H), 3.52-3.58 (m, 2H), 2.99-3.10 (m, 2H), 1.87-1.95 (m, 2H), 1.73-1.80 (m, 2H), 1.28-144 (m, 3H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=387.5.
Example 21 Preparation of Compound 5n
(226) 5n was synthesized using 5h in General Procedure D. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.22 (s, 1H), 8.08-8.14 (m, 1H), 7.89-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.85 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.39-7.45 (m, 1H), 7.28-7.33 (m, 1H), 4.78 (s, 2H), 4.23-4.27 (m, 2H), 3.64-3.69 (m, 2H), 3.10-3.19 (m, 2H), 2.80-2.87 (m, 1H), 2.17-2.24 (m, 2H), 1.78-1.84 (m, 2H), 1.57-1.66 (m, 2H), 1.28-1.42 (m, 3H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=401.5.
Example 22 Preparation of Compound 5o
(227) 5o was synthesized using 5i in General Procedure D. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.03-8.09 (m, 1H), 7.88-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.29-7.34 (m, 1H), 4.76 (s, 2H), 4.33-4.41 (m, 2H), 3.66-3.72 (m, 1H), 3.53-3.60 (m, 2H), 3.30-3.38 (m, 2H), 3.02-3.10 (m, 2H), 2.39-2.51 (m, 2H), 1.86-1.97 (m, 2H), 1.73-1.82 (m, 2H), 1.28-1.42 (m, 3H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=415.6.
Example 23 General Procedure E
(228) ##STR00237##
(229) Methylsulfonyl chloride (1.0 equiv) and diisopropylethylamine (3.0 equiv) were added to 5g-5i (0.028 mmol) and dissolved in dimethylformamide (200 μL). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with methanol and water and purified using reverse-phase preparative HPLC with a methanol/water gradient.
Example 24 Preparation of Compound 5g
(230) 5p was synthesized using 5g in General Procedure E. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.30 (s, 1H), 8.08-8.14 (m, 1H), 7.87-7.92 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.85 (m, 1H), 7.46-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.39-7.45 (m, 1H), 7.25-7.30 (m, 1H), 4.89-4.96 (m, 1H), 4.80 (s, 2H), 3.64-3.73 (m, 2H), 2.94-3.05 (m, 2H), 2.76 (s, 3H), 2.13-2.28 (m, 2H), 2.00-2.10 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=437.6.
Example 25 Preparation of Compound 5q
(231) 5q was synthesized using 5h in General Procedure E. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.04-8.11 (m, 1H), 7.88-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.39-7.45 (m, 1H), 7.29-7.35 (m, 1H), 4.78 (s, 2H), 4.26 (d, J=6.9, 2H), 3.59-3.69 (m, 2H), 2.78 (s, 3H), 2.57-2.68 (m, 2H), 1.98-2.06 (m, 1H), 1.55-1.63 (m, 2H), 1.34-1.40 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=451.6.
Example 26 Preparation of Compound 5r
(232) 5r was synthesized using 5i in General Procedure E. .sup.1H NMR (CD.sub.3OD, 300 MHz) δ 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.03-8.09 (m, 1H), 7.88-7.94 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.54 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.29-7.34 (m, 1H), 4.76 (s, 2H), 4.34-4.41 (t, J=6.9, 2H), 3.50-3.59 (m, 2H), 2.76 (s, 3H), 2.31-2.43 (m, 2H), 1.66-1.81 (m, 4H), 1.35-1.40 (m, 1H), 1.10-1.17 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=465.6.
Example 27 Preparation of Compound 5d
(233) To compound B (0.107 g, 0.43 mmol) in ethanol (2 mL), t-butyl hydrazine hydrochloride (0.054 g, 0.43 mmol) and triethylamine (59 μL, 0.43 mmol) were added. After refluxing for 3.5 h, the solvent was evaporated and water was added. The solid was collected and then refluxed in formamide (6 mL) overnight. The cold reaction mixture was diluted with water and the precipitate was collected. This precipitate was re-dissolved in chloroform and then purified by silica gel chromatography using a methanol-chloroform gradient to yield 5d (0.025 g, 18%). .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.24-8.32 (m, 2H), 7.93 (m, 1H), 7.81 (m, 1H), 7.52-7.58 (m, 2H), 7.39 (m, 1H), 7.13 (m, 1H), 4.81 (s, 2H), 1.66 (s, 9H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=332.4.
Example 28 Preparation of Intermediate C
(234) ##STR00238##
(235) Commercially available 5-amino-1H-pyrazole-4-carbonitrile (2.0 g, 18.5 mmol) was mixed with formamide (10 mL) and heated to 180° C. overnight under nitrogen. The solution was cooled to rt, 60 mL of water was added, and the resulting precipitate was collected by vacuum filtration to yield C (2.367 g, 95%). .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.13 (s, 1H), 8.06 (s, 1H).
Example 29 Preparation of Intermediate D
(236) ##STR00239##
(237) Compound C (2.367 g, 17.5 mmol) and N-iodosuccinimide (4.810 g, 21.4 mmol) were added to dimethylformamide (60 mL) and stirred at 50° C. for 24 hours. Another batch of N-iodosuccinimide (0.871 g, 3.8 mmol) was added to the reaction mixture and was allowed to stir for an additional 24 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature and water (100 mL) was added, forming a precipitate that was collected by filtration to yield D (4.1 g, 89%). .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.18 (s, 1H).
Example 30 Preparation of Compound 6
(238) ##STR00240##
(239) A mixture of D (1.0 g, 3.8 mmol), K.sub.2CO.sub.3 (2.135 g, 15.4 mmol), and isopropyl iodide (421 μL, 4.2 mmol) were dissolved in dimethylformamide (7.5 mL). The reaction was heated to 80° C. and left to run overnight. An extraction with saturated sodium acetate and ethyl acetate was performed. The organic layer was dried with sodium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was purified using silica gel chromatography with a methanol/dichloromethane gradient to yield 6 (673 mg, 58%). .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.19 (s, 1H), 4.93-5.03 (m, 1H), 1.43 (d, J=6.9, 6H).
Example 31 General Procedure F
(240) ##STR00241##
(241) Compound 6 (1 equiv), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine) palladium(0) (0.05 equiv), and sodium carbonate (2.3 equiv) were added to the appropriate boronic acid or pinacol ester (1.1 equiv) in dimethoxyethane (1 mL) and water (0.5 mL). The reaction was performed in a microwave at 85° C. for one hour, followed by extraction with ethyl acetate and water. The organic layer was collected and concentrated in vacuo to yield the crude product. The crude product was then purified via flash chromatography with an ethyl acetate/hexanes gradient.
Example 32 Preparation of Compound 7a
(242) 7a was synthesized using 4-chlorophenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.32 (s, 1H), 7.57 (m, 4H), 5.19 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 1.61 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=288.8.
Example 33 Preparation of Compound 7b
(243) 7b was synthesized using 3-chlorophenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.40 (s, 1H), 7.76 (s, 1H), 7.60 (m, 1H), 7.46-7.50 (m, 2H), 5.21 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 1.62 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=288.8.
Example 34 Preparation of Compound 7c
(244) 7c was synthesized using 3,4-dichlorophenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.41 (s, 1H), 7.86 (s, 1H), 7.56-7.66 (m, 2H), 5.21 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 1.61 (d, J=6.6, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=323.3.
Example 35 Preparation of Compound 7d
(245) 7d was synthesized using 4-isopropylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.38 (s, 1H), 7.64 (d, J=8.0, 2H), 7.41 (d, J=8.0, 2H), 5.20 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 3.01 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 1.61 (d, J=6.6, 6H), 1.32 (d, J=6.9, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=296.4.
Example 36 Preparation of Compound 7e
(246) 7e was synthesized using 3-isopropylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.38 (s, 1H), 7.38-7.68 (m, 4H), 5.20 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 3.01 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 1.62 (d, J=6.8, 6H), 1.32 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=296.4.
Example 37 Preparation of Compound 7f
(247) 7f was synthesized using 4-methylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.33 (s, 1H), 7.59 (d, J=7.7, 2H), 7.36 (d, J=7.7, 2H), 5.20 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 2.46 (s, 3H), 1.62 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=268.4.
Example 38 Preparation of Compound 7g
(248) 7g was synthesized using 3-methylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.59 (m, 3H), 7.31 (s, 1H), 5.16 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 2.43 (s, 3H), 1.61 (d, J=6.6, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=268.4.
Example 39 Preparation of Compound 7h
(249) 7h was synthesized using 3,4-dimethylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.50 (m, 2H), 7.31 (s, 1H), 5.19 (sep, J=6.6, 1H), 2.37 (s, 3H), 2.35 (s, 3H), 1.61 (d, J=6.6, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=282.4.
Example 40 Preparation of Compound 7i
(250) 7i was synthesized using 4-fluoro-3-methylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.38 (s, 1H), 7.45-7.58 (m, 2H), 7.15 (m, 1H), 5.19 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 2.39 (s, 3H), 1.61 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=286.4.
Example 41 Preparation of Compound 7j
(251) 7j was synthesized using 4-methoxyphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.59 (m, 2H), 7.08 (m, 2H), 5.19 (sept, J=6.8, 1H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 1.61 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=284.4.
Example 42 Preparation of Compound 7k
(252) 7k was synthesized using 3,4-dimethoxyphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.38 (s, 1H), 7.21-7.27 (m, 2H), 7.02-7.06 (m, 1H), 5.19 (sep, J=6.9, 1H), 3.97 (m, 6H), 1.62 (d, J=6.9, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=314.4.
Example 43 Preparation of Compound 71
(253) 7l was synthesized using 3,4,5-trimethoxyphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.39 (s, 1H), 6.91 (s, 2H), 5.22 (sep, J=6.9, 1H), 3.95 (s, 6H), 3.92 (s, 3H), 1.62 (d, J=6.9, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=344.5.
Example 44 Preparation of Compound 7m
(254) 7m was synthesized using 4-methoxy-3-methylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.49 (m, 2H), 6.99 (m, 1H), 5.19 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 3.91 (s, 3H), 2.32 (s, 3H), 1.61 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=298.4.
Example 45 Preparation of Compound 7n
(255) 7n was synthesized using 3-acetylphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.41 (s, 1H), 8.32 (s, 1H), 8.08 (d, J=8.2, 1H), 7.95 (d, J=8.2, 1H), 7.67 (m, 1H), 5.23 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 1.63 (d, J=6.6, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=296.4.
Example 46 Preparation of Compound 7o
(256) 7o was synthesized using naphthalene-1-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz δ 8.30 (s, 1H), 8.03-8.11 (m, 2H), 7.85-7.90 (m, 1H), 7.50-7.69 (m, 4H), 5.13 (septet, J=6.8, 1H), 1.53 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=304.4.
Example 47 Preparation of Compound 7p
(257) 7p was synthesized using naphthalene-2-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.19 (s, 1H), 7.84-8.04 (m, 4H), 7.56-7.62 (m, 2H), 5.25 (septet, J=6.7, 1H), 1.66 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=304.4.
Example 48 Preparation of Compound 7q
(258) 7q was synthesized using 6-methoxynaphthalene-2-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.77-7.94 (m, 2H), 7.64-7.73 (m, 2H), 7.21 (s, 1H), 5.23 (septet, J=6.9, 1H), 3.98 (s, 3H), 1.65 (d, J=6.9, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=334.4.
Example 49 Preparation of Compound 7r
(259) 7r was synthesized using 6-ethoxynaphthalene-2-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.76-7.92 (m, 3H), 7.19-7.23 (m, 2H), 5.23 (sep, J=6.6, 1H), 4.21 (q, J=6.9, 2H), 1.61 (d, J=6.6, 6H), 1.52 (t, J=6.9, 3H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=348.4.
Example 50 Preparation of Compound 7s
(260) 7s was synthesized using 2-methoxynapthalene-3-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.38 (s, 1H), 8.03 (s, 1H), 7.80-7.89 (m, 2H), 7.50-7.57 (m, 2H), 7.40-7.46 (m, 1H), 5.23 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 3.98 (s, 3H), 1.66 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=334.4.
Example 51 Preparation of Compound 7t
(261) 7t was synthesized using quinoline-3-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 9.27 (s, 1H), 8.46 (m, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 8.17 (d, J=8.4, 1H), 7.91 (d, J=8.4, 1H), 7.77 (m, 1H), 7.62 (m, 1H), 5.22 (sep, J=6.9, 1H), 1.61 (d, J=6.9, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=305.4.
Example 52 Preparation of Compound 7u
(262) 7u was synthesized using 3,4-methylenedioxyphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.14-7.21 (m, 2H), 6.95-7.00 (m, 1H), 6.06 (s, 2H), 5.18 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 1.61 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=298.4.
Example 53 Preparation of Compound 7v
(263) 7v was synthesized using 1,4-benzodioxane-6-boronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 500 MHz) δ 8.30 (s, 1H), 7.18 (s, 1H), 7.06-7.14 (m, 2H), 5.20 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 4.36 (s, 4H), 1.63 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=312.4.
Example 54 Preparation of Compound 7w
(264) 7w was synthesized using 3,4-dihydrochromen-6-ylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.35 (s, 1H), 7.35-7.41 (m, 2H), 6.92-6.98 (m, 1H), 5.18 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 4.27 (t, J=5.2, 2H), 2.89 (t, J=5.2, 2H), 2.03-2.12 (m, 2H), 1.61 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=310.4.
Example 55 Preparation of Compound 7x
(265) 7x was synthesized using dibenzo[b,d]thiophen-4-ylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 500 MHz) δ 8.47 (s, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 7.72 (d, J=7.6, 1H), 7.66 (d, J=7.6, 1H), 7.54 (s, 1H), 7.47 (t, J=7.6, 1H), 7.39 (t, J=7.6, 1H), 5.24 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 1.65 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=360.5.
Example 56 Preparation of Compound 7y
(266) 7y was synthesized using 3-Benzylphenylboronic acid pinacol ester in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.35 (s, 1H), 7.56 (m, 1H), 7.42-7.52 (m, 2H), 7.29-7.37 (m, 3H), 7.16-7.27 (m, 3H), 5.19 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 4.08 (s, 2H), 1.61 (d, J=6.7, 6H). (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=344.4.
Example 57 Preparation of Compound 7z
(267) 7z was synthesized using 3-Biphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.40 (s, 1H), 7.94 (s, 1H), 7.61-7.75 (m, 5H), 7.40-7.53 (m, 3H), 5.22 (sep, J=6.8, 1H), 1.64 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=330.4.
Example 58 Preparation of Compound 7aa
(268) 7aa was synthesized using 3-Benzyloxyphenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 8.40 (s, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.37-7.55 (m, 5H), 7.15-7.26 (m, 3H), 5.14-5.27 (m, 3H), 1.64 (d, J=6.8, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=360.5.
Example 59 Preparation of Compound 7ab
(269) 7ab was synthesized using 3-Methylthiophenylboronic acid in General Procedure F. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.38 (s, 1H), 7.56 (s, 1H), 7.36-7.50 (m, 3H), 5.21 (sep, J=6.7, 1H), 2.56 (s, 3H), 1.63 (d, J=6.7, 6H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=300.4.
Example 60 General Procedure G (Compounds 1 and 2)
(270) ##STR00242##
(271) Intermediates E: To malononitrile (1.0 equiv) in THF (15 mL) and sodium hydride (2.0 equiv, 95% dispersion in paraffin oil), the appropriate acyl chloride (1.0 equiv) was added dropwise at 5-10° C. After 3 hours, the reaction mixture was warmed to room temperature and hydrochloric acid (45 mL) was added. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (3×75 mL) and the organic layer was dried over Na2SO4 to yield intermediate E.
(272) Intermediates F: To sodium hydrogen carbonate (8.0 equiv) in 1,4-dioxane (12 mL) and water (2 mL), compound E (1.0 equiv) and dimethyl sulfate (7.0 equiv) were added slowly. After stirring at 85° C. for 2.5 h, water (60 mL) was added. Extraction with tert-butyl methyl ether (4×50 mL), drying of the organic layer with Na2SO4, and silica gel chromatography using an ethyl acetate/hexanes gradient yielded intermediate F.
(273) Compounds 1 and 2: To compound F (1.0 equiv) in ethanol (2 mL), t-butyl hydrazine hydrochloride (1.0 equiv) and triethylamine (1.0 equiv) were added. After refluxing for 3.5 h, the solvent was evaporated and water was added. The solid was collected and then refluxed in formamide (6 mL) overnight. The cold reaction mixture was diluted with water and the precipitate was collected. This precipitate was re-dissolved in chloroform and then purified by silica gel chromatography using a methanol-chloroform gradient to yield final compound.
(274) 1 was synthesized using 1-naphthoyl chloride as the acyl chloride in General Procedure G. .sup.1H NMR (CDCl.sub.3, 300 MHz) δ 8.25 (s, 1H), 7.97-8.10 (m, 2H), 7.77-7.85 (m, 1H), 7.55-7.67 (m, 4H), 1.91 (s, 9H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=318.4.
(275) 2 was synthesized using 2-naphthoyl chloride as the acyl chloride in General Procedure G. .sup.1H NMR (DMSO-d.sub.6, 300 MHz) δ 8.33 (s, 1H), 8.19 (s, 1H), 7.98-8.10 (m, 3H), 7.78-7.83 (m, 1H), 7.57-7.62 (m, 2H), 1.79 (s, 9H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+=318.4.
Example 61 Preparation of Intermediate G
(276) ##STR00243##
(277) Phthalimide (354 mg, 2.35 mmol), 3-chloropyrazin-2-yl methanol (284 mg, 1.96 mmol), and resin bound triphenylphosphine (1.55 g, 2.35 mmol) were added to anhydrous THF. To this reaction mixture, DIAD (507 mg, 2.35 mmol) was added dropwise. After 12 h the reaction mixture was concentrated. The crude product was purified using silica gel chromatography with a hexane/dichloromethane gradient to yield Intermediate G (300 mg, 56% yield). .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ□ 5.17 (s, 2H), 7.77-7.83 (m, 2H), 7.87-7.97 (m, 2H), 8.29-8.34 (m, 2H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+274.2.
Example 62 Preparation of Intermediate H
(278) ##STR00244##
(279) Anhydrous hydrazine (0.05 mL, 1.37 mmol) was added to a solution of Intermediate G (150 mg, 0.5 mmol) in 3.0 mL of dichloromethane at rt under an inert atmosphere. After 2.5 h, 4.5 mL of MeOH was added and the reaction mixture was stirred at reflux for 19 h. The reaction mixture was cooled to rt and the white precipitate that formed was filtered off. The precipitate was washed with ether (3×) and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo. The resultant solid was re-dissolved in EtOAc and filtered again. The solution was concentrated to afford 77 mg (97% yield) of pure product. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, MeOD) δ□ 4.08 (s, 2H), 8.34 (d, 1H, J=2.7 Hz), 8.58 (d, 1H, J=2.7 Hz). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+143.9.
Example 63 Intermediate I
(280) ##STR00245##
(281) Intermediate H (26 mg, 0.19 mmol), isobutyric acid (0.02 mL, 0.2 mmol), EDCI (50 mg, 0.25 mmol), DIEA (0.1 mL, 0.5 mmol), and DMAP (5.7 mg, 0.038 mmol) were dissolved in 2.0 mL of dichloromethane. The reaction mixture was stirred at rt overnight and then concentrated in vacuo. The resultant residue was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with water (2×), NaHCO.sub.3(1×), and brine (1×). The organic layer was dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 37 mg (93% yield) of pure Intermediate I. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 1.21-1.26 (m, 6H), 2.46-2.59 (m, 1H), 4.69 (d, 2H, J=4.5 Hz), 8.32-8.34 (m, 1H), 8.46 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz).
Example 64 Intermediate J
(282) ##STR00246##
(283) POCl.sub.3 (0.08 ml, 0.90 mmol) was added to Intermediate I (37 mg, 0.18 mmol) dissolved in 0.78 mL of acetonitrile. A drop of DMF was added and the reaction mixture was stirred at 55° C. for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture was then concentrated in vacuo and the resultant solid was dissolved in 2 M ammonia in methanol followed by concentrating this solution in vacuo. The resultant solid was dissolved in a minimal amount of water and the product was extracted into dichloromethane (4×). The organic layers were combined and washed with saturated NaHCO.sub.3, (1×), concentrated in vacuo, and dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. Concentration of the solution afforded 33 mg (98% yield) of Intermediate J. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ□ 1.46 (d, 6H, J=6.9 Hz), 3.29-3.38 (m, 1H), 7.33 (d, 1H, J=4.8 Hz), 7.61 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz), 7.82 (s, 1H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+196.
Example 65 Intermediate K
(284) ##STR00247##
(285) Intermediate J (33 mg, 0.17 mmol) dissolved in 0.18 mL of DMF was added to NIS (39 mg, 0.17 mmol) dissolved in 0.6 mL of DMF. The reaction mixture was heated to 60° C. for 3 h and then cooled to room temperature. The reaction mixture was partitioned between 1 M Na.sub.2SO.sub.3 and dichloromethane. The aqueous layer was then extracted with dichloromethane (3×). The organic layers were combined, dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4 and concentrated in vacuo to afford 34 mg (62% yield) of pure Intermediate K. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 1.41 (d, 6H, J=6.9 Hz), 3.20-3.31 (m, 1H), 7.28 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz), 7.65 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+322.1.
Example 66 Intermediate L
(286) ##STR00248##
(287) Intermediate K (33 mg, 0.10 mmol) and NH.sub.4OH were heated to 80° C. for 6 h in a microwave. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and purified using silica gel chromatography with a hexane/EtOAc gradient to yield Intermediate L (33 mg, 66% yield). .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 1.4 (d, 6H, J=5.4 Hz), 3.17-3.26 (m, 1H), 5.88 (br s, 2H), 7.02 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz), 7.23 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+303.2.
Example 67 Intermediate M
(288) ##STR00249##
(289) Intermediate H (104 mg, 0.76 mmol), pivalic acid (0.08 mL, 0.8 mmol), EDCI (200 mg, 1.0 mmol), DIEA (0.4 mL, 2.0 mmol), and DMAP (22 mg, 0.15 mmol) were dissolved in 8.0 mL of dichloromethane. The reaction mixture was stirred at rt overnight and then concentrated in vacuo. The resultant residue was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with water (2×), NaHCO.sub.3(1×), and brine (1×). The organic layer was dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 145 mg (94% yield) of pure Intermediate M. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ□ 1.15 (s, 9H), 4.59 (d, 2H, J=4.8 Hz), 8.31-8.34 (m, 1H), 8.42 (d, 1H, J=2.4 Hz).
Example 68 Intermediate N
(290) ##STR00250##
(291) POCl.sub.3 (0.12 ml, 1.35 mmol) was added to Intermediate M (54 mg, 0.27 mmol) dissolved in 1.2 mL of acetonitrile. A drop of DMF was added and the reaction mixture was stirred at 55° C. for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture was then concentrated in vacuo and the resultant solid was dissolved in 2 M ammonia in methanol followed by concentrating this solution in vacuo. The resultant solid was dissolved in a minimal amount of water and the product was extracted into dichloromethane (4×). The organic layers were combined and washed with saturated NaHCO.sub.3(1×), concentrated in vacuo, and dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4. Concentration of the solution afforded 45 mg (95% yield) of Intermediate N. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 1.35 (s, 9H), 7.38 (m, 1H), 7.66 (m, 1H), 7.87 (s, 1H). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+210.1.
Example 69 Intermediate O
(292) ##STR00251##
(293) Intermediate N (45 mg, 0.25 mmol) dissolved in 0.23 mL of DMF was added to NIS (51 mg, 0.22 mmol) dissolved in 0.8 mL of DMF. The reaction mixture was heated to 60° C. for 3 h and then cooled to room temperature. The reaction mixture was partitioned between 1 M Na.sub.2SO.sub.3 and dichloromethane. The aqueous layer was then extracted with dichloromethane (3×). The organic layers were combined, dried over Na.sub.2SO.sub.4 and concentrated in vacuo to afford 49 mg (70% yield) of pure Intermediate O. .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 1.31 (s, 9H), 7.23 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz), 7.67 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+336.4.
Example 70 Intermediate P
(294) ##STR00252##
(295) Intermediate O (76 mg, 0.22 mmol) and NH.sub.4OH were heated to 80° C. for 6 h in a microwave. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and purified using silica gel chromatography with a hexane/EtOAc gradient to yield Intermediate P (76 mg, 66% yield). .sup.1H-NMR (300 MHz, CDCl.sub.3) δ 1.32 (s, 9H), 5.28 (br s, 2H), 7.06 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=5.1 Hz). MS (ESI) (M+H).sup.+317.1.
Example 71 General Procedure H
(296) Intermediates L or O (0.03 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine) palladium(0) (0.05 equiv), and sodium carbonate (2.3 equiv) were added to the appropriate boronic acid or pinacol ester (1.1 equiv) in dimethoxyethane (1 mL) and water (0.5 mL). The reaction was performed in a microwave at 85° C. for one hour, followed by extraction with ethyl acetate and water. The organic layer was collected and concentrated in vacuo to yield the crude product. The crude product was then purified via flash chromatography with an ethyl acetate/hexanes gradient.
Example 72 Preparation of Compounds 8-12 and 69-72
(297) Compounds 8-12 and 69-72 (Table B) were generated with General Procedure H using the appropriate substituted boronic acid as is familiar to those skilled in the art.
Example 73 Preparation of Compounds 81-149
(298) Compounds 81-149 were prepared according to the general procedures using the appropriate substituted boronic acid as is familiar to those skilled in the art.
(299) TABLE-US-00009 Compound No. Structure 81
Example 74 Preparation of Compound 150
(300) ##STR00322##
3-(6-ethoxynaphthalen-2-yl)-1-((1-methylpiperidin-4-yl)methyl)-1H-pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidin-4-amine (150)
(301) This compound was synthesized as shown in the scheme below.
(302) ##STR00323##
BIOLOGICAL EXAMPLES
Biological Example 1 Enzymology of TgCDPK1
(303) Two types of enzyme assays were developed to follow TgCDPK1 activity, a radiometric scintillation proximity assay measured the labeled γ-phosphate of ATP added to a biotinylated peptide substrate and an ATP consumption assay where ATP consumption was monitored by luciferase and light production (KinaseGlo®, Promega Corp., Madison, Wis.). Both assays gave similar results for calcium dependence, K.sub.m of substrates (less than 2-fold differences in Km values; see Table 6
(304) TABLE-US-00010 TABLE 6 K.sub.m and IC.sub.50 values for TgCDPK1 enzyme Inhibitor Enzyme Mean Substrate IC.sub.50 values (μM)* concn K.sub.m NM-PP1 NA-PP1 NA-PP2 Assay Type (nM) ATP Peptide (Cmpd 3) (Cmpd 1) (Cmpd 2) SPA 2 10 ± 2 12 ± 2 0.025 0.484 0.006 KinaseGlo 2 12.38 20.48 0.02 0.816 0.005 *ATP value of 12.4 μM and Peptide 10 μM Note: Enzyme concentrations are 10-fold less than shown in Table 7, substrate concentrations are different than Table 7, and the incubation time is 90 min instead of 30 min as shown in Table 7.
(305) TABLE-US-00011 TABLE 7 Inhibitor IC.sub.50 values at different TgCDPK1 enzyme concentrations Enzyme incubation IC.sub.50 values (μM)# concn time NM-PP1 NA-PP1 NA-PP2 (nM) (min) (Cmpd 3) (Cmpd 1) (Cmpd 2) 20 30 0.066 0.989 0.018 2 90 0.039 0.978 0.008 #TgCDPK1 data at ATP value of 10 μM and Peptide 40 μM, with coupled KinaseGlo assay. Note, a longer incubation time was necessary for the lower enzyme concentration to get reliable measurements for the IC.sub.50 calculation.
(306) As expected, activity of TgCDPK1 on the peptide substrates required addition of exogenous calcium (
Biological Example 2 Structure of TgCDPK1
(307) We have determined X-ray crystal structures of Ca.sup.2+-free TgCDPK1 in the apo form and in complex with two potent inhibitors (Table 1 and
(308) TABLE-US-00012 TABLE 1 Data collection and refinement statistics. SAD Apo NA-PP2 NM-PP1 (SeMet) (native) (SeMet) (native) Data collection Space group P2.sub.1 P2.sub.1 P2.sub.1 P2.sub.1 Cell dimensions a, b, c(Å) 48.2, 72.0, 67.5 48.1, 71.9, 67.3 48.1, 72.5, 67.1 47.2, 72.9, 65.7 α, β, γ (°) 90.0, 102.9, 90.0 90.0, 103.0, 90.0 90.0, 103.8, 90.0 90.0, 98.8, 90.0 Resolution (Å) 90-2.30 (2.38-2.30)* 50-2.04 (2.12-2.04) 50-1.98 (2.06-1.98) 50-1.99 (2.06-1.99) Unique reflections 20,099 (1,986) 28,324 (2,799) 30,0803 (2,996) 30,350 (2,975) R.sub.merge 0.11 (0.95) 0.05 (0.67) 0.09 (0.70) 0.06 (0.74) I/σI 13.1 (2.4) 17.0 (2.4) 8.4 (2.1) 14.2 (1.9) Completeness (%) 100 (100) 99.9 (100) 98.1 (96.6) 99.8 (98.1) Redundancy 7.7 (7.7) 4.2 (4.2) 3.7 (3.6) 4.2 (4.1) Wilson B factor (Å.sup.2) 43.7 34.8 26.6 29.7 Refinement Resolution (Å) 36.89-2.04 29.72-1.98 35.72-1.99 No. reflections 26,871 29,224 28,797 No. reflections test set 1,431 1,556 1,536 R.sub.work/R.sub.free 0.213/0.258 0.193/0.245 0.192/0.228 No. atoms Protein 3,674 3,776 3,743 Nonprotein 79 194 167 B-factors (Å.sup.2) Protein (Mean B.sub.iso + B.sub.TLS) 60.2 42.5 48.7 Nonprotein (Mean B.sub.iso) 27.7 27.1 24.0 R.m.s. deviations Bond lengths (Å) 0.006 0.007 0.006 Bond angles (°) 0.866 0.978 0.878 PDB code 3i79 3i7c 3i7b *Values in parentheses are for highest-resolution shell.
(309) The structure of the catalytic domain is typical of serine/threonine type protein kinases. The two Ca.sup.2+-binding EF-hand lobes and connecting extended helical stem of the calmodulin-like regulatory domain lie along one face of the kinase domain, adjacent to the active site (
Biological Example 3 Bumped Kinase Inhibitors (BKIs) and TgCDPK1
(310) Most known kinase inhibitors bind in the ATP-binding pocket of the active site.sup.19,20. These inhibitors exploit many of the same hydrophobic contacts as the purine ring of ATP and make at least one conserved hydrogen bond to the hinge region. Potent inhibitors also occupy at least one hydrophobic pocket adjacent to the ATP-binding site. These additional hydrophobic interactions increase both binding affinity and target selectivity of the inhibitor because there is substantial heterogeneity among different kinases in these regions. Examination of the TgCDPK1 sequence in the vicinity of the ATP-binding pocket (
(311) Shokat and colleagues have shown that mutation of bulky gatekeeper residues to glycine renders mutant kinases uniquely susceptible to inhibition by a class of kinase inhibitors called “bumped kinase inhibitors” (BKIs). BKIs are analogs of 4-amino-1-tert-butyl-3-phenylpyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidine (Table 2) that are derivatized at C3 with bulky aromatic groups.sup.24.
(312) TABLE-US-00013 TABLE 2 Inhibition of wt TgCDPK1 and TgCDPK1 (Met gatekeeper) by bumped kinase inhibitors.* Inhibitor NA-PP1 NA-PP2 NM-PP1 Wild type TgCDPK1 0.989 0.018 0.066 (IC50 in μM) G128M TgCDPK1 173 21.44 36.18 (IC50 in μM) Chemical structure
The large sidechain of the gatekeeper residue in most kinases prevents access of the C3 bulky aromatic substituent to the more hydrophobic pocket at the back of the catalytic cleft rendering them insensitive to BKI inhibition.sup.21,22. Large gatekeeper amino acids like methionine or phenylalanine severely restrict access by the BKIs, while small residues such as the glycine present in TgCDPK1 are most permissive.sup.22,23,25,26. Studies with genetically engineered mice that express mutant kinases with small gatekeeper residues (glycine or alanine), have demonstrated that BKIs preferentially target the mutant kinases.sup.27-29. The well-documented lack of BKIs inhibition of mammalian kinases suggests that this class of compounds may be very selective for TgCDPK1 during T. gondii infection.sup.27-29.
(313) Based on structural and sequence analysis of the differences in ATP-binding sites of typical mammalian kinases and TgCDPK1 with a small gatekeeper (
(314) The crystal structure of TgCDPK1 in complex with two potent BKIs were determined (NA-PP2,
Biological Example 4 TgCDPK1 Appears in the Cytoplasm and Nucleus of T. gondii Cells
(315) The mode of action of TgCDPK1 is unknown but its localization in the cell might provide clues to its cellular function. To this end, TgCDPK1 was fused with green fluorescent protein (GFP) to facilitate its localization within live intracellular T. gondii. TgCDPK1-GFP was found in both the cytosol and the nucleus (
Biological Example 5 Effects of BKIs on Toxoplasma gondii Cell Entry and Growth
(316) We tested three BKIs for effects on host cell invasion and parasite growth since earlier work on TgCDPK1.sup.14 suggested a key role for this enzyme in T. gondii invasion. As shown in
(317) T. gondii expressing CDPK1-GFP, CDPK1(G128M)-GFP, or GFP were mixed with the indicated concentration of NA-PP2 and added to the fibroblast monolayer for 15 min at 4° C. to allow binding (Kafsack et al). The samples were then raised to 37° C. for 4 min to allow invasion. Samples were fixed, washed, and stained with antibody to T. gondii surface antigens (SAG, Argene) to identify extracellular parasites.
(318) T. gondii overexpressing CDPK1-GFP, CDPK1(G128M)-GFP, or GFP were mixed with wild type cells (105 of each) in medium with or without 1 μM NA-PP2. Parasites were allowed to infect fibroblasts on cover slips and grown overnight. Samples were stained with DAPI to identify host and parasite nuclei and vacuoles with 2 or more T. gondii cells (only fully invaded parasites can replicate) were counted. Each vacuole was assessed for GFP expression by the parasites. .
(319) We expect that longer exposure to BKIs would increase the impact of the drug on T. gondii growth, as egressed parasites are prevented from invading new cells. Each BKI was tested for its effects on human fibroblast replication; the EC.sub.50s were found to be approximately 1000-fold higher (not shown) than those seen in the T. gondii “invasion” assay.
Biological Example 6 T. gondii Cell Expressing the G128M Gatekeeper Mutant Demonstrate that BKIs Act Through TgCDPK1 In Vivo
(320) We transfected the T. gondii cell line with expression plasmids encoding an HA tag fused to the C-terminus of either wild type TgCDPK1 or the G128M gatekeeper mutant. Immunoblot analysis showed that the wild type and G128M mutant TgCDPK1s were expressed to similar levels (
(321) We have shown that TgCDPK1 is a promising drug target for the therapy of toxoplasmosis. Its kinase activity is uniquely sensitive to inhibition by BKIs, and BKI treatment in turn blocks entry of the parasite into mammalian cells. Blocking cell entry is important because T. gondii is an obligate intracellular parasite and cannot replicate without invasion. Moreover, these experimental findings address concerns about quantitative differences between enzyme inhibition and cellular effects thereby validating the utility of TgCDPK1 structures in complex with BKIs to drive drug development for toxoplasmosis therapy. The concept of using BKIs for the therapy of toxoplasmosis is bolstered by the fact that BKIs have been used in mouse studies with no demonstration of toxicity or troublesome effects to the animals.sup.27-29. Thus, BKIs have promise; as a selective drug for toxoplasmosis therapy because they are non-toxic to mammals but prevent cell entry and thus the replication of T. gondii.
(322) Since the structure was determined for the inactive, Ca.sup.2+-free form of TgCDPK, there may be some concern that this form would not be optimal to guide the design of small molecule inhibitors with improved potency and selectivity. It is apparent from structural and biochemical studies presented here, however, that small molecule inhibitors can still access the ATP-binding site of the Ca.sup.2+-free conformation of TgCDPK1. Importantly, the structure of the active site near the ATP-binding pocket, particularly in the vicinity of the gatekeeper residue, is not significantly altered between the structures shown here and that of the Ca.sup.2+-bound enzyme in complex with AMP-PNP (Wemimont et al. submitted for publication, PDB 3h×4). Thus, structure-guided optimization of small molecule inhibitors that target this region is possible using the inactive, Ca.sup.2+-free form of TgCDPK1.
(323) TgCDPK1 was localized in the cytoplasm, but also found in the nucleus. Some plant CDPKs are also partially localized to the nucleus. In those CDPKs, nuclear localization is mediated by a signal in the junction domain.sup.18, but the T. gondii protein is not homologous in this region and no nuclear localization signal is predicted by standard programs. Since the size of the protein is above the threshold for free diffusion through the nuclear pore, we propose that the protein could bear a non-canonical nuclear localization sequence or piggyback into the nucleus on another protein. As noted earlier, Raymond Hui's group has demonstrated a Ca.sup.2+-dependent structural rearrangement that repositions the regulatory domain to the opposite side of the catalytic domain (Wernimont et al. submitted for publication, PDB accession number 3h×4). This observation of Ca.sup.2+-induced structural rearrangement raises the intriguing, but speculative, possibility that Ca.sup.2+ could modulate localization by revealing or occluding the relevant region of the kinase. In any case, these results raise the possibility that TgCDPK1 phosphorylates specific nuclear proteins in addition to its presumably cytosolic targets involved in gliding motility.
(324) Drug-resistant mutations of the TgCDPK1 gatekeeper to a bulky residue could eventually emerge under selective pressure of BKI therapy. One strategy to suppress the emergence of resistance is the co-administration of two drugs targeting different proteins. As TgCDPK1 is not the target of any existing drug, the development of an anti-TgCDPK1 compound could provide a partner drug for co-administration with another drug. Most transmission of T. gondii is not from person-to-person (although this can occur in pregnancy, transplantation, or transfusion), but rather through zoonotic cycles where drug pressure is not exerted.sup.1. This suggests that if drug resistance emerges it will largely be confined to the individual, posing little threat to the utility of the drug in other infected persons.
(325) As other apicomplexan pathogens employ CDPK enzymes with a small gatekeeper residue, this work may have broader applicability. For instance, the TgCDPK1 ortholog in Cryptosporidium parvum also has a glycine residue at the gatekeeper position (
Biological Example 7 Expression, Purification and Assay of Recombinant Mutant and Wild Type TgCDPK1
(326) TgCDPK1 (GI: 12484153, ToxoDB ID 162.m00001) or its G128M mutant, cloned into pAVA0421, was expressed in BL21*(DE3) E. coli (Invitrogen Corp. Carlsbad, USA) for 72 hours at 20° C. in a LEX Bioreactor (Harbinger Biotechnology & Engineering Corp. Ontario Canada). Cells collected from 2 liters of culture were lysed in 200 ml of 30 mM imidazole, 500 mM NaCl, 25 mM HEPES, 5% glycerol, 0.025% azide, 1 mM TCEP, 10 mM MgCl.sub.2, 1 mM AEBSF, pH 7.0 and incubated with Benzonase® (Novagen, USA) for 30 min at room temperature before centrifugation at 14,000 rpm for 75 min and 4° C. Clarified supernatant was loaded onto 5 ml Ni.sup.2+ HisTrap FF resin columns pre-equilibrated with 30 mM imidazole, 500 mM NaCl, 25 mM HEPES, 5% glycerol, 0.025% azide, 1 mM TCEP. Recombinant histidine-tagged protein was eluted in 220 mM imidazole pH 7.0. Fractions were subsequently separated on AKTA Prime size exclusion columns (HiLoad™ 26/60 Superdex 75™ prep grade) pre-equilibrated 500 mM NaCl, 25 mM HEPES, 5% glycerol, 0.025% azide, 2 mM DTT, pH 7.0. The N terminal hexahistidine tag was removed by 3 C protease cleavage at a 1:50 mg ratio and dialyzed overnight at 4° C. in 200 mM NaCl, 20 mM HEPES, 5% glycerol, 1 mM TCEP, pH 7.0 with final separation on Ni.sup.2+ Sepharose™ 6 Fast Flow resin. Fractions were analyzed for purity by SDS-polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis and found to be >99% pure.
(327) Two types of kinase assays were employed, an ATP consumption assay and a scintillation proximity assay. ATP consumption kinase assays were performed using a nonradioactive KinaseGlo® luciferase assay (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA). Kinase phosphorylation reactions were performed in a buffered medium containing 20 mM HEPES pH 7.5 (KOH), 0.1% BSA, 10 mM MgCl.sub.2, 1 mM EGTA (pH 7.2), plus or minus 2 mM CaCl.sub.2.sup.14. The phosphorylation reaction mixture of 40 μM peptide substrate (Syntide-2, peptide sequence: Pro-Leu-Ala-Arg-Thr-Leu-Ser-Val-Ala-Gly-Leu-Pro-Gly-Lys-Lys (SEQ ID NO: 12)) (GenScript, Piscataway, USA), 19.48 nM of 14 TgCDPK1, 90 to 0.0005 μM serial dilutions of inhibitor in a total volume of 25 μl, was initiated by the addition of 10 μM ATP. The reaction was terminated after 30 minutes incubation at 30° C. by addition of excess EGTA (5 mM final concentration). Internal positive and negative controls were included in each assay run. No activity was detected when the peptide substrate was left out of the reaction mixture. Unused ATP was measured in luminescence based readout as counts per seconds on the Chameleon 425-104 multi-label plate scintillation counter (Hidex, Oy, Turku Finland). A second enzyme assay, based on the scintillation proximity assay, directly measured the attachment of γ-phosphate to peptide substrate. The scintillation proximity assay was used for confirmation of enzymatic characteristics like K.sub.m for ATP and substrate and for confirmation of IC50s of the inhibitors. Phosphorylation of biotinated peptide substrate, (Bio-Syntide-2, American Peptide Company, Inc. Sunnyvale, Calif.) was determined by serial titrations in scintillation proximity assays using streptavidin coated Beads and [γ-.sup.33P] ATP (PerkinElmer, Boston, USA) as previously described.sup.30.
Biological Example 8 Site-Directed Mutagenesis
(328) Site-directed mutagenesis of the predicted gate keeper glycine residue to methionine was executed with Stratagene kit. PCR amplification of pAVA0421-TgCDPK1 plasmid DNA with page purified primers TgDPKmetS (GGC TAC TTC TAC CTC GTC ATG GAA GTG TAC ACG GGA GGC GAG TTG)(SEQ ID NO: 3) and TgDPKmetAS (CAA CTC GCC TCC CGT GTA CAC TTC CAT GAC GAG GTA GAA GTA GCC)(SEQ ID NO: 4) was carried out at 95° C. (30 seconds), 95° C. (30 seconds), 55° C. (1 minute), 68° C. (6:00 minutes) followed by 68° C. (6:00 minutes) repeated in 16 cycles. Dpn I digested PCR products was transformed into XL10-Gold ultracompetent E. coli cell (Stratagene) with selection on LB agar supplemented with 100 μg/ml ampicillin. Mutant plasmids was recovered with alkaline denaturation method using the QIAGEN plasmid purification kits and verified by nucleotide sequence analysis before transformation into protein expression E. coli strain BL21*(DE3) (Invitrogen Corp. Carlsbad, USA). Induction of expression and purification of mutant TgCDPK1(G128M) in E. coli BL21*(DE3) (Invitrogen Corp. Carlsbad, USA) was previously described.sup.30.
Biological Example 9 Protein Crystallization
(329) Purified TgCDPK1 protein was screened for crystallization leads using a Phoenix crystallization robot (Art Robbins Instruments, Sunnyvale, Calif.) and the JCSG+ Suite sparse matrix crystallization screen (Qiagen, Valencia, Calif.).sup.31. A few leads were further optimized by finer grid screening around the initial hit using sitting-drop vapor diffusion at room temperature. Diffraction-quality crystals of native and selenomethionyl-derivatized (SeMet) protein (˜18-26 mg/ml) were grown from mother liquor composed of 0.18-0.25 M (di- or tri-) ammonium citrate (pH 6.5-7.0), 22-26% polyethylene glycol (PEG) 3350, and 5 mM dithiothreitol. For inhibitor cocrystals, the crystallization drop was additionally supplemented with a final concentration of 4 mM inhibitor dissolved in dimethylsulfoxide. Thin pointed rods or plates approximately 50-150 μm long typically grew within one week. Crystals were mounted in cryoloops (Hampton Research, Aliso Viejo, Calif.) and directly frozen in liquid nitrogen or were first transferred to a fresh drop of mother liquor containing 10-20% ethylene glycol for, typically, less than 20 seconds prior to freezing. For inhibitor co-crystals, 2-4 mM inhibitor was maintained in the cryoprotection solution.
Biological Example 10 Structure Determination
(330) Crystals of TgCDPK1 were screened at the Stanford Synchrotron Research Lightsource (SSRL) on beamline 9-2 using the SSRL automated mounting (SAM) system.sup.32. All data were collected at 100 K on a MarMosaic-325 CCD detector using the Blu-Ice software package.sup.33. Single-wavelength anomalous dispersion (SAD) data were collected from a single crystal of SeMet protein.sup.34 at a wavelength of 0.9792 Å, the Se peak wavelength determined from a fluorescence scan of the crystal. All other datasets were also collected at or near the Se peak wavelength; apo (native) at 0.9792 Å, NA-PP2 complex (SeMet) at 0.9791 Å, and NM-PP1 complex (native) at 0.9795 Å. All data were processed using HKL2000.sup.35. Data collection statistics are presented in Table 1.
(331) Initially, we were able to solve the structure of the kinase domain by molecular replacement (MR) using MOLREP.sup.36 or Phaser.sup.37 with the structure of the kinase domain of the orthologous protein from Cryptosporidium parvum (PDB ID 3dfa) as the search model. Although representing nearly two-thirds of the total protein content of the asymmetric unit, the resulting MR phases were not good enough to allow tracing of the novel calmodulin-like regulatory domain; despite significant effort at manual improvement of the MR solution and attempts to additionally place various calmodulin-like domains of very low sequence identity by MR. We thus turned to using SeMet protein in order to obtain experimental phase information to solve the complete structure. Using a SeMet SAD dataset, SOLVE.sup.38 located 12 of 14 expected selenium atoms and produced initial phases to approximately 2.7 Å. The resulting phases were input into RESOLVE.sup.38 using the RESOLVE_BUILD script (http://www.solve.lanl.gov/Resolve/html_resolve_manual/resolve_build.txt) for density modification and automated model building. The model was significantly improved by bootstrapping the results back into the RESOLVE_BUILD script two more times for rebuilding. Iterated manual model building and restrained refinement continued using Coot.sub.39 and REFMAC5.sup.40. This model was transferred into the other datasets by MR using Phaser followed by a few rounds of model building and improvement in Coot and refinement with REFMAC5. The improved models were then submitted to ARP/wARP.sup.41 for rebuilding using and continued cycles of building and restrained refinement ensued. Based on the initial, unbiased difference density present in the active sites of the cocrystal structures, it was immediately clear that the inhibitors had bound the enzyme. Ideal coordinates and refinement restraints for use in REFMAC5 and Coot for these ligands were created with the PRODRG server.sup.42. In the final cycles of refinement, perturbational displacement of the protein was described by a multi-group translation/libration/screw (TLS) model, with group boundaries suggested by the TLSMD server.sup.43,44, that were refined prior to restrained refinement. Model quality was monitored and validated using Coot and MolProbity.sup.45. All final models display good Ramachandran statistics. For the final apo model, 97.6% of the residues are in favored regions of the Ramachandran plot with no outliers. The NA-PP2 complex model has 98.9% of residues in favored regions with no outliers and the NM-PP1 complex has 98.5% of residues in favored regions and Gly420 is an outlier. The CCP4 suite of programs.sup.46,47 was used for all steps from data preparation through refinement. Model refinement statistics are presented in Table 1. Structural figures were created and rendered using PyMOL (Delano Scientific, Palo Alto, Calif.).
(332) Atomic coordinates and structure factors have been deposited in the Protein Data Bank.sup.48. (http://www.pdb.org) with accession numbers 3i79 (apo), 3i7c (NA-PP2 complex), and 3i7b (NM-PP1 complex).
Biological Example 11 T. Gondii Growth/Invasion Assay and Expression of TgCDPK1-HA and TgCDPK1(G128M)
(333) The TgCDPK1 coding region or its G128M mutant were amplified from the E. coli expression plasmids using primers to insert 3 adenine nucleotides before the start codon and mutate the second codon from glycine to alanine, allowing for enhanced expression in the parasite.sup.49. The products were inserted into the BglII/AvrII site of T. gondii transfection vector pCAT-GFP.sup.50 or pHx-ACP-YFP.sup.51 to yield in frame fusions with GFP or YFP, under the control of the tubA or Gra1 promoters respectively. Plasmids encoding HA-tagged versions of the molecules were created by replacing the YFP sequence with one that specifies four C-terminal HA epitopes. Linearized constructs were electroporated into RH strain T. gondii according to standard methods.sup.52 and transfected parasites were used to infect human foreskin fibroblasts growing on cover slips. In some cases a T. gondii strain expressing β-galactosidase under control of the TubA promoter, as well as GFP under control of the GRA1 promoter, was employed (kind gift of Gustavo Arrizabalaga).sup.53.
(334) Immunofluorescence analysis was performed as described.sup.52 using rabbit anti-GFP (Invitrogen Corp. Carlsbad, USA) followed by goat anti-rabbit IgG coupled to Texas red (Southern Biotechnology). DNA was stained with DAPI. Samples were viewed on a Nikon Eclipse E600 using a Plan Apo 60×1.4 na objective.
(335) T. gondii cells expressing β-galactosidase were grown in the presence of serial concentrations of BKIs. All assays were performed in triplicate and the mean and standard deviation are presented unless otherwise noted. In the growth assays, 10.sup.3 parasites were allowed to infect a confluent layer of fibroblasts in each well of a 96 well plate. After 4 hr, drug was added to the indicated final concentration. To assess effects on invasion, compounds were added prior to the addition of the parasites. The cultures were incubated for 20 hours at 37° C. and β-galactosidase was assayed as earlier described using chlorophenol red O-galactopyranose (CPRG, Sigma) as substrate.sup.54. Plates were developed at 37° C. for 4 hr (growth), 8 hr (invasion), or 10 hr (CDPK expression) and absorbance was measured at 595 nm on a Versamax microplate reader.
(336) Cytotoxicity was analyzed by adding medium containing up to 50 μM of each compound to a confluent layer of fibroblasts; plates were incubated at 37° C. for 4 days. Alamar blue (Alamar Biosciences, Sacramento, Calif.) was added to each well and developed over night.
Biological Example 12 CpCDPK1
(337) The sensitivity of CpCDPK1 to compounds 1-3 was determined with an in vitro activity assay (
(338) Based on the ability of pyrazolopyrimidine inhibitors to block T. gondii and C. parvum host cell invasion, compounds were further optimized based on this scaffold as potent and selective dual inhibitors of TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1. Two synthetic routes were used to generate derivatives that contain varying substituents at the 1- and 3-positions of the pyrazolopyrimidine core as described in the preceding synthetic examples.
(339) Inhibition of TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 was determined using a luminescent kinase assay which measures ATP depletion in the presence of the Syntide 2 peptide substrate (KinaseGlo). (U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 61/299,286, and reference 9) Similar to TgCDPK1, exogenous calcium was necessary for CpCDPK1 to possess maximum catalytic activity (data not shown). Notably, both kinases were tested at the same ATP concentration which allows direct comparison of inhibitor potencies due to these enzymes possessing similar K.sub.ms for this cofactor. (20)
(340) Encouraged by the similar potency of inhibitor 3 against TgCDPK1 (IC.sub.50=150±20 nM) and CpCDPK1 (IC.sub.50=130±40 nM), pyrazolopyrimidine analogues that contain a naphthylmethylene group at the 3-position and various alkyl substituents at the 1-position were tested for their ability to inhibit both kinases (Table 3).
(341) TABLE-US-00014 TABLE 3 In vitro activities of 3, 5a-5r against TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1. Values shown are the average of three assays ± (SEM).
(342) Derivatives containing smaller alkyl groups (5a-5c) were found to have reduced potencies for both enzymes relative to 3. Furthermore, a significant increase in potency was not observed for inhibitors that contain bulkier substituents at the 1-position (5d-5f). However, the reduced potencies of compounds with larger substituents is not due to a size restriction in the ATP-binding pocket because derivatives that contain a basic piperidine group (derivatives 5g-5i) were found to be significantly more potent inhibitors of TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1. Notably, compound 5h, which contains a methylene linkage between the pyrazolopyrimidine core and piperidine ring, has an 8-fold and 16-fold lower IC.sub.50 for CpCDPK1 and TgCDPK1 than parent compound 3, respectively. Derivatization of 5g-5i with an acetyl (5j-5l), ethyl (5m-5o), or sulfonylmethyl (5p-5r) group reduces the enhanced potency that the piperidine substituent confers, with only modified versions of piperidine 5g showing similar inhibition as the parent compound. Notably, most compounds from this series are near equipotent inhibitors of both TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1, demonstrating the overall similarity in this region of the ATP-binding pockets of both kinases.
(343) To further probe the hydrophobic pocket adjacent to the gatekeeper residue (Hydrophobic Pocket II) a series of analogs that contain an isopropyl group at the 1-position and various aryl substituents at the 3-position were tested for their ability to inhibit both kinases (Table 4, compounds 7a-7ab). While many of these inhibitors were not expected to be as selective for CpCDPK1 and TgCDPK1 over mammalian kinases as naphthylmethylene derivatives 3 and 5a-5r, we felt that this series of compounds would provide insight into which substituents can be accommodated in this region. As shown in Table 4, a large number of aryl substituents are accommodated by both kinases. Almost all of the compounds from this series have an IC.sub.50 less than 1 μM, with several inhibitors demonstrating very high potency against both enzymes. Inhibitors that contain aryl rings that are mono-substituted with smaller substituents at the meta (7b, 7e, 7g, and 7ab) or para positions (7a, 7d, 7f, and 7j) are accommodated in the ATP-binding sites of both kinases but are more potent against TgCDPK1 than CpCDPK1. However, neither kinase is inhibited by compounds that contain aryl rings that are meta-substituted with larger substituents at the 3-position (7y, 7z, and 7aa). Analogues that contain meta- and para-substituted aryl rings (7c, 7i, 7k, and 7m) are potent against both enzymes and show reduced selectivity for TgCDPK1. Consistent with this observation, pyrazolopyrimidine derivatives that contain a 2-naphthyl (7p-7r) or quinoline group (7t) are potent inhibitors of both enzymes. However, bicyclic substituents that are not planar show reduced potency (7u-7w). In general, most inhibitors from this series are 2- to 12-fold selective for TgCDPK1 over CpCDPK1. However, several compounds (for example, compounds 7l, 7q and 7t) are equipotent or slightly selective for CpCDPK1. This fact demonstrates that while the ATP-binding pockets of both kinases are very similar they are not identical.
(344) TABLE-US-00015 TABLE 4 In vitro activities of 7a-5ab against TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1. Values shown are the average of three assays ± (SEM).
(345) Key to the use of pyrazolopyrimidine-based kinase inhibitors as anti-parasitic agents is the potential to selectively inhibit TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 over mammalian kinases. To determine the potency of these compounds against mammalian kinases, a subset of inhibitors were tested against the tyrosine kinases SRC and ABL. We felt that these two kinases would be a suitable counter-screen because they both contain the most permissive gatekeeper residue found in mammalian kinases (threonine) and the pyrazolopyrimidine core was originally developed as a kinase inhibitor scaffold against SRC-family kinases. (21) As shown in Table 5, most of the pyrazolopyrimidines tested have limited activity against SRC and ABL. Consistent with earlier studies, previously-characterized “bumped” inhibitors 1 and 3 do not potently inhibit SRC or ABL kinase. Despite the increased activity of analogue 2 against TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1, this compound only weakly inhibits SRC and ABL (IC.sub.50>1 μM).
(346) TABLE-US-00016 TABLE 5 Activities of various inhibitors against human kinases and human cell lines. Values shown are the average of three assays ± (SEM). Compound IC.sub.50 (μM) GI.sub.50 (μM) Number Abl Src CRL8155 HL60 HCC2998 SF539 1 >20 1.3 (0.2) >10 >10 >10 >10 2 6.0 (1.5) 1.9 (0.2) >10 >10 >10 >10 3 7.9 (2.0) 8.8 (0.8) >10 >10 >10 >10 5d 7.7 (3.8) 2.2 (0.5) >10 >10 >10 >10 5h >20 >20 >10 >10 >10 >10 5m 0.36 (.05) 0.21 (.06) — — — — 5n >20 >20 >10 >10 >10 >10 5o >20 4.2 (2.1) — — — — 5p 0.090 (.019) 0.36 (.07) >10 >10 >10 >10 7c 0.07 (.02) 0.035 (.008) >10 >10 >10 >10 7e 0.20 (.02) 0.22 (.02) — — — — 7p 0.075 (.024) 0.065 (.009) >10 >10 ~10 >10 7q 0.82 (.04) 0.77 (0.10) >10 >10 >10 >10 7r.sup. 1.7 (0.5) 0.20 (.03) — — — — 7t 0.86 (.06) 2.7 (0.6) >10 >10 >10 >10
(347) As expected, pyrazolopyrimidine inhibitors that contain smaller aryl groups at the 3-position (7c and 7e) are less selective for both parasite kinases due to their increased potency against SRC and ABL. However, analogues that contain a substituted naphthyl (7q and 7r) or quinoline (7t) substituent at the 3-position are much more selective due the increased size of these functional groups. Presumably, the larger threonine gatekeeper residues of SRC and ABL restrict access of these inhibitors to Hydrophobic Pocket II. While the substituent at the 3-position is the major contributor to inhibitor selectivity, substitution at the 1-position affects the potency of these compounds against TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 relative to SRC and ABL. For example, piperidine-containing analogues 5m and 5p are less selective for TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 than parent compound 1. However, several analogues restore the high selectivity of this class of compounds, with secondary piperidine 5h demonstrating over 1000-fold selectivity for the CDPKs. To test the overall toxicity of our pyrazolopyrimidines inhibitors, they were assayed for their ability to inhibit the growth of four human cell lines (Table 5): glioma derived (SF539), human lymphocyte (CRL8155), human promyelocytic leukemia (HL-60) and colorectal carcinoma (HC 2998). For all four cell lines tested, the inhibitors showed little or no growth inhibition at the highest concentration tested (10 μM).
(348) We have previously reported crystal structures of inhibitors 2 and 3 bound to TgCDPK1. (U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 61/299,286, and reference 9) Similar to the structures of other pyrazolopyrimidines bound to tyrosine kinases, these inhibitors occupy the ATP-binding cleft of TgCDPK1. The pyrazolopyrimidine scaffold superimposes with the purine ring of ATP, with the exocyclic amine and nitrogen at the 5-position forming hydrogen-bonding interactions with the hinge region. In addition, the glycine gatekeeper residue of TgCDPK1 allows bulky substituents at the 3-position unobstructed access to Hydrophobic Pocket II. Replacing glycine with a larger amino acid at this position clearly creates a steric clash with the 2-naphthyl and 1-naphthylmethylene groups of inhibitors 2 and 3, respectively. (8) Based on the similar sensitivities of TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 to pyrazolopyrimidines we predicted that inhibitors of this class would bind in a similar orientation in both enzymes. The structure of compound 3 bound to CpCDPK1 shows that this is indeed the case (
(349) It is therefore clear that the inhibitors are able to bind the ATP-binding site of CDPK1 whether it is active or not.
(350) While structures of both enzymes bound to 2 and 3 provided direct insight into how large substituents can be accommodated at the 3-position, we were interested in further exploring how substitution at the 1-position affects the potencies of these inhibitors. Structures of inhibitor 5h bound to TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 show how increased potency can be obtained. While the pyrazolopyrimidine cores and 3-position substituents of inhibitors 3 and 5h make identical contacts with both enzymes, the piperidine ring of 5h forms a salt bridge with a glutamate residue that lines the ATP-binding cleft. Importantly, this interaction is present in the structures of 5h bound to both TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1. Presumably, alkylation, acetylation or sulfonylation of the piperidine ring disrupts this interaction and accounts for the lower potency of compounds 5j-5r. Furthermore, the reduced potency of 5h against SRC and ABL demonstrates that these kinases cannot form a similar interaction.
(351) In conclusion, we have demonstrated that selective pyrazolopyrimidine kinase inhibitors are indeed potent inhibitors of CpCDPK1 and that they are able to inhibit an early stage of C. parvum cell invasion. This class of compounds have a similar effect on the ability of T. gondii to invade human fibroblast cells. (U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 61/299,286, and reference 9) Based on these results, a diverse panel of pyrazolopyrimidine analogues was generated and their activities against CpCDPK1 and TgCDPK1 were determined. By exploiting a unique sequence and structural variation in the ATP-binding clefts of TgCDPK1 and TgCDPK1 potent dual inhibitors of these enzymes were obtained. Importantly, many of these inhibitors show minimal inhibition of the tyrosine kinases SRC and ABL and are not toxic to human cell lines. Additionally, other derivatives of pyrazolopyrimidine may be useful and such variations on the compounds discussed herein are contemplated. For example, the potency and selectivity of these compounds and optimization their PK/ADME/Tox properties. Furthermore, optimized inhibitors may be able to be used to inhibit C. parvum host cell invasion.
Biological Example 13 TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 IC.SUB.50 .Data
(352) The following compounds were tested for inhibition of TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 (Table 8) according to the preceding methods:
(353) TABLE-US-00017 TABLE 8 TgCDPK1 and CpCDPK1 IC.sub.50 data IC.sub.50 (μM) Cmpd # TgCDPK1 CpCDPK1 1 1.619 >3.0 2 0.015 0.059 3 0.128 0.147 5a 0.458 0.413 5b 0.086 0.13 5c 1.923 2.038 5d 0.031 0.144 5e 1.848 >3.0 5f 0.946 2.416 5g 0.059 0.056 5h 0.015 0.009 5i 0.052 0.034 5j 0.091 0.103 5k 0.208 0.36 5l 0.104 0.179 .sup. 5m 0.036 0.05 5n 0.269 0.163 5o 0.093 0.103 5p 0.054 0.075 5q 0.563 0.691 5r 0.117 0.194 7a 0.018 0.216 7b 0.02 0.115 7c 0.004 0.013 7d 0.048 0.213 7e 0.014 0.059 7f 0.013 0.087 7g 0.019 0.114 7h 0.009 0.022 7i 0.009 0.053 7j 0.04 0.41 7k 0.037 0.173 7l 0.42 0.093 .sup. 7m 0.005 0.017 7n 1.483 2.068 7o 0.326 0.62 7p 0.005 0.01 7q 0.006 0.005 7r 0.005 0.012 .sup. 7s 0.863 0.591 7t 0.024 0.02 7u 0.045 0.312 7v 0.181 0.984 .sup. 7w 0.017 0.11 7x >3.0 >3.0 7y 0.322 1.402 7z 2.229 >3.0 7aa 1.058 1.894 7ab 0.056 0.121 8 0.0048 0.0078 9 0.04 0.032 10 0.078 0.0336 11 0.0103 0.0573 12 0.0032 0.0532 13 0.553 0.894 14 0.627 0.953 15 0.149 0.265 16 0.9609 >3.0 17 0.98 1.554 18 >3.0 >3.0 19 0.0638 0.3705 20 0.0036 0.003 21 >3.0 >3.0 22 1.142 >3.0 23 >3.0 >3.0 24 0.0119 0.0704 25 0.0038 0.0073 26 0.0091 0.0162 27 0.0569 0.6231 28 0.0049 0.0023 29 0.0038 0.0035 30 0.1144 0.0837 31 0.1168 0.0936 32 0.0038 0.0051 33 0.0026 0.0046 34 0.0023 0.0021 35 0.0037 0.0044 36 0.003 0.0032 37 0.0013 0.0008 38 0.0007 0.0006 39 0.0007 0.0004 40 0.0008 0.0497 41 0.0006 0.0041 42 0.0009 0.054 43 0.0054 0.244 44 0.0037 0.0067 45 0.015 0.092 46 0.0106 0.1017 47 0.0055 0.2717 48 0.1366 1.5858 49 0.0186 0.2102 50 0.0522 1.0316 51 0.0159 0.2624 52 0.0043 0.3728 53 0.012 0.2723 54 0.0159 0.1471 55 0.0163 0.0307 56 0.004 0.1052 57 0.01 0.0134 58 0.1357 0.5877 59 0.0997 0.8319 60 0.0666 0.9289 61 0.0684 0.9269 62 0.0409 0.6918 63 0.0462 0.4168 64 0.1429 0.9285 65 0.1706 1.1576 66 0.1777 2.0183 67 0.1963 0.8222 68 >3 >3 69 0.0046 0.0107 70 0.0042 0.0022 71 0.0049 0.0053 72 0.0249 0.0123
Biological Example 14 Tyrosine Kinase IC.SUB.50 .Data
(354) The following compounds were tested for inhibition of human tyrosine kinases SrcKD, Src3D, AblKD, Abl3D, HckKD (Table 9) according to the preceding methods:
(355) TABLE-US-00018 TABLE 9 Tyrosine Kinase IC.sub.50 data IC.sub.50 (μM) Cmpd # SrcKD Src3D AblKD Abl3D HckKD 1 1.3 >20.0 2 1.9 6 3 8.8 7.9 1.382 5d 2.2 7.7 5h >20.0 >20.0 >10.0 .sup. 5m 0.21 0.36 5n >20.0 >20.0 5o 4.2 >20.0 5p 0.36 0.09 7c 0.035 0.07 7e 0.22 0.2 7p 0.065 0.075 7q 0.77 0.576 0.82 0.375 7r 0.2 0.549 1.7 0.218 7t 0.2 1.7 9 0.686 2.01 11 0.475 0.628 2.36 0.541 12 0.298 0.307 0.838 0.244 20 0.294 0.238 24 1.45 0.353 25 5.02 0.969 26 1.242 0.304 28 >20.0 >20.0 >10.0 29 >20.0 >20.0 >10.0 30 >20.0 >20.0 32 >10.0 >10.0 >10.0 33 >10.0 >10.0 >10.0 34 3.063 >10.0 1.613 35 >10.0 >10.0 >10.0 36 >10.0 >10.0 >10.0 37 1.759 >10.0 38 0.375 0.497 39 1.551 >10.0 40 0.038 0.043 0.316 41 0.199 0.675 42 0.784 1.68 43 0.263 1.153 44 >10.0 7.34 45 >10.0 7.326 48 0.8832 1.701 49 0.1118 0.0333 50 0.1966 1.073 51 0.4003 1.798 52 0.1067 1.267 53 0.1911 1.23 54 0.1254 0.194 55 0.897 0.6492 57 >10 >10 68 >10 >10 69 3.9 >10 70 2.38 4.79 71 6.09 >10 72 >10 6.35 83 >10 4.159 84 1.287 0.0862 85 0.0948 0.403 90 0.094 91 0.01 92 >10 ~10 94 >10 0.554 99 >10 >10 118 >10 >10 120 >10 >10 123 >10 >10 124 3.78 7.845 132 0.1773 2.943 134 0.5796 1.636 135 2.01 4.861 137 2.21 8.040 138 5.02 139 0.5210 1.589 140 0.1286 0.6356 142 2.10 143 4.13 144 >10 5.982 145 >10 >10 146 0.0366 0.172 148 5.58 149 8.68 150 >10 >3
Biological Example 15 Expression, Purification and P. falciparum Enzyme Activity Assays
(356) Recombinant PfCDPK1 and PfCDPK4 proteins were expressed in E. coli (Rosetta Oxford strain) and lysed in 25 mM HEPES (pH 7.0), 500 mM NaCl, 500 glycerol, 0.500 CHAPS, 30 mMv imidazole, 1 mMv TCEP, 250 μg/ml AEBSF, 0.025% azide, and 2.5 U/mL benzonase nuclease (Novagen). Soluble recombinant enzymes were purified as earlier described by Ojo et al. (23), which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. A luminescence assay that measures the depletion of ATP in the presence of the peptide substrate, Syntide 2 (PLARTLSVAGLPGKK) (24,9), was used to determine the catalytic activity of these enzymes. Assays were performed with 10 μM ATP, 40 μM Syntide-2, and 6.6 nM or 22 nM of PfCDPK1 and PfCDPK4, respectively, in 20 mM HEPES (pH 7.5), 0.1% BSA (w/v), 10 mM MgCl.sub.2, 1 mM EGTA, with or without 2 mM CaCl.sub.2. The BKI compound library previously described by Murphy et al. (24), which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety, was tested at serial concentrations between 3 μM and 1 nM.
Biological Example 16 PfCDPK4 Binding Mode Modeling
(357) The kinase domain of PfCDPK4 was modeled by the I-TASSER server (25,26) using structures of TgCDPK1 available in the Protein Data Bank as a template. Subsequent docking of Compound 29 into the active site of this model was carried out using QXP/FLO (27) (version +0602). Compound 29 was initially placed in the active site of PfCDPK4 by SSM superposition (28) of an in-house TgCDPK1:Compound 29 co-crystal structure (PDB citation pending). The binding pocket was defined as all residues within 10 Å of the roughly-placed inhibitor. Protein atoms were fixed with the exception of sidechain atoms that project into the binding pocket. The two H-bonds between the pyrazolopyrimidine inhibitor scaffold and the hinge region of the kinase, which are conserved in most ATP/ATP-homolog:kinase complexes, were restrained. The interaction between the nitrogen of the R2 piperidine and the sidechain of Glu154 was also restrained because we see this interaction in >15 co-crystal structures of TgCDPK1/CpCDPK1 with BKIs containing the methylpiperidine R2 substituent (24). Docking of Compound 29 was subsequently carried out using 1100 cycles of Metropolis Monte Carlo conformational searching followed by energy minimization. The 25 lowest energy binding modes were visually inspected and favorable conformations were selected.
Biological Example 17 P. berghei Maintenance and Genetic Modification
(358) The P. berghei ANKA wild type clone 2.34 and the transgenic lines derived from it were maintained in Theiler's Original (TO) or Swiss Webster outbred mice and infections monitored on Giemsa-stained blood films. The cdpk4.sup.− mutant clone and its complementation with P. berghei cdpk4 were described previously by Billker et al., which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. A transfection vector for complementing the cdpk4.sup.− mutant with Pfcdpk4 was generated by replacing the P. berghei sequence in plasmid p150 with a Pfcdpk4 sequence amplified by PCR from P. falciparum 3D7 gametocyte cDNA as an NheI-ApaI restriction fragment, placing it in frame with a carboxy terminal 2× myc epitope tag, a 3′UTR and terminator derived from the P. berghei dhfr/ts gene. Following verification of the Pfcdpk4 sequence, the plasmid was linearized in a unique HpaI site within the cdpk4 5′ intergenic region and transfected into P. berghei cdpk4′ using established protocols (29). Homologous insertion of the complementation vector into the upstream intergenic region of the cdpk4 mutant placed Pfcdpk4 under the control of the endogenous P. berghei promoter. Transgenic clones were genotyped by diagnostic PCR followed by Southern blot analysis.
Biological Example 18 Phenotypic Analysis of P. berghei Gametocytes Expressing PfCDPK4-2x-myc and Sensitivity to Compound 29
(359) Expression of CDPK4-2x-myc proteins was verified by western blot analysis of mixed asexual parasite and gametocytes purified from peripheral blood of infected mice by ammonium chloride lysis. Parasites were suspended and lysed in SDS loading buffer containing 0.1 M DTT. Protein blots were probed with anti-myc mouse monoclonal antibody 9E10 (Sigma) at 1:2000 dilution. To assess the effect of complementation, exflagellation was quantified 3 to 4 days post infection by adding 4 μl of blood from a superficial tail vein to 150 μl exflagellation medium (RPMI1640 containing 25 mM HEPES (Sigma), 10% FCS, 100 μM xanthurenic acid, pH 7.5). Between 15 and 18 minutes after activation the number of exflagellating microgametocytes was counted in a haemocytometer and the red blood cell (RBC) count determined. The percentage of RBCs containing microgametocytes was assessed on Giemsa-stained blood smears and the number of exflagellations per 100 microgametocytes was then calculated. Ookinetes formation was analysed in-vitro largely as described (30), by culturing gametocyte-infected mouse blood in exflagellation medium for 24 h at 19° C. Conversion from macrogametocytes to ookinetes was assessed by staining live cultures with Cy3-conjugated monoclonal antibody 13.1 against the macrogamete/ookinete surface marker P28. The conversion rate was determined as the number of banana shaped ookinetes as a percentage of the total number of P28 expressing cells. For the experiments monitoring exflagellation after compound administration, mice bearing P. berghei gametocytes expressing PfCDPK4-2×-myc were treated with 50 mg/kg i.p. of BKI-2 or NA-PP2 or vehicle (90% saline 7% EtOH 3% DMSO), bled at the time points noted in
Biological Example 19 P. berghei Transmission Experiments
(360) Mice were injected i.p. with drug or vehicle 3 days after an infection had been initiated with ˜10.sup.6 P. berghei ANKA parasites constitutively expressing GFP (31). After 30 minutes treated mice were anaesthetized by i.p. injection of a mixture of ketamine (Ketalar®, 80 mg/kg) and xylazine (Rompun®, 8 mg/kg) and exposed to 25 female A. stephensi mosquitoes. After 5 days midguts were dissected, imaged using a fluorescence microscope and oocysts quantified.
Biological Example 20 P. falciparum Transmission Experiments
(361) P. falciparum strain NF54 parasites were cultured in RPMI 1640 supplemented with 50 μM hypoxanthine and 10% A+ human serum. Cultures were started at 0.5% and grown for 16 days with daily media changes. Beginning on day 14 exflagellation was monitored. On Day 16, all cultures were pooled and re divided into 4 flasks to which BKIs were added for 30 minutes at 50 nM, 100 nM, 300 nM, 1 μM and 3 μM with one flask as a vehicle-only control and NA-PP2 flasks with 50 nM, 300 nM, and 3 μM. A wet mount was taken to check exflagellation and monitored beginning at 10 minutes and observed until 25 minutes had elapsed. Each flask of culture was fed to approximately 150 4 day old A. stephensi mosquitoes for 20 minutes. Ten days post feed ˜50 mosquitoes from each cage was checked for midgut oocyst infection. On day 14 remaining mosquitoes in each cage were dissected and pooled to check for salivary gland sporozoites.
(362) Administration of 50 mg/kg Compound 29 intraperitoneally (i.p.) resulted in a peak plasma concentration of 8.2 μM and plasma levels exceeding 0.4 μM for 20 hours post-treatment (
(363) P. berghei gametocyte-infected mice was injected i.p. with Compound 29 at 10 mg/kg, a dose which has no impact on asexual parasitaemia or gametocyte rates, but is sufficient to block exflagellation (not shown) to assess its impact on malaria transmission to mosquitoes. Anopheles stephensi mosquitoes were allowed to feed on treated mice 30 minutes after dosing. We used P. berghei with WT expression of PbCDPK4, because of the results of
Biological Example 21 Inhibition of P. falciparum Proliferation
(364) The following compounds were tested for inhibition P. falciparum (PfCDPK1, PfCDPK4) enzymes and ability to block P. falciparum proliferation according to the preceding methods:
(365) TABLE-US-00019 TABLE 10 Inhibition of P. falciparum proliferation Enzyme Inhibition (EC50, μM) Proliferation PfCDPK1 PfCDPK4 Blocking Compound (% inhibition (% inhibition P. falciparum No. @ 3 uM) PfCDPK1 @ 3 uM) PfCDPK4 (EC.sub.50, μM) 8 92 0.1559 92 0.091 9 76 88 10 93 0.3804 94 0.3282 1 51 25 2 1.25 0.48 40 11 93 0.3729 87 0.5486 12 95 0.6585 91 0.5256 3 78 76 >50 5f 15 13 25 5e 5 5a 52 14 13 15 11 5b 20 5c 45 23 16 13 17 44 5 18 4 19 14 5d 76 86 5g 56 75 20 0.309 93 0.2307 7a 97 86 7b 72 85 7c 93 97 7d 90 80 7e 74 52 7f 96 85 7g 72 64 7h 83 85 7j 87 30 .sup. 7m 77 85 7i 79 79 7n 51 10 7o 58 79 7p 95 0.3805 98 0.1421 7z 79 21 7ab 85 79 7t 65 1.3569 83 0.1688 5i 58 80 0.6029 7q 0.2081 0.0414 >10 7aa 75 18 7r 94 1.2874 99 0.4288 >50 .sup. 7s 53 20 21 68 9 22 71 9 5h 66 95 0.1543 7k 93 1.3614 43 >3 7u 94 0.4219 77 1.105 7l 85 31 23 75 11 7v 27 7x 21 .sup. 7w 55 7y 17 24 0.4709 93 0.3366 25 92 0.5785 26 93 0.5438 27 0.8794 44 >3 5j 48 5p 53 .sup. 5m 42 5k 69 28 5q 78 15 5n 49 27 5l 51 41 5r 55 22 5o 71 37 28 92 0.7394 99 0.0188 31.9 29 97 0.3527 101 0.0139 6.16 30 82 86 31 51 40 32 0.3652 96 0.0554 33 0.1959 98 0.0211 >10 34 0.0272 97 0.0302 5.83 35 0.1514 99 0.0312 >10 36 0.1462 99 0.0157 11.7 37 0.0958 96 0.0716 38 0.0452 96 0.0349 7 39 102 0.0211 98 0.0092 7 40 101 0.0963 84 0.5136 41 101 0.0363 98 0.0192 >10 42 101 0.1557 94 0.3084 43 100 0.2775 78 1.2037 44 100 0.1817 97 0.0583 45 101 0.0565 82 0.3497 46 95 0.4772 52 >3 47 91 1.2856 51 1.4322 48 84 2.279 10 >3 49 88 0.688 22 2.3458 50 83 2.0926 26 >3 51 86 1.5998 92 0.2595 52 93 1.0749 62 1.2272 39.5 53 98 0.5317 57 1.6358 54 101 0.0478 77 0.4376 55 100 0.2160 94 0.1750 56 93 1.1375 73 0.8877 57 85 0.7055 82 0.2427 58 97 0.2142 50 2.4330 59 98 0.1107 79 0.4586 60 98 0.0664 85 0.3257 >10 61 101 0.0714 80 0.5146 7 62 102 0.0377 95 0.1402 >10 63 103 0.0118 96 0.1355 >10 64 101 0.1279 66 1.0831 65 101 0.1012 53 2.8532 66 100 0.2868 77 2.1832 67 96 0.3249 49 1.9874 68 70 2.2040 9 >3 69 101 0.1978 97 0.1320 81 73 75 82 56 >3 4 >3 70 100 0.0538 96 0.0834 71 101 0.0676 98 0.0652 72 94 0.9484 91 0.2412 73 87 14 74 97 0.3473 68 1.0132 75 75 5 83 96 1.0779 93 0.3714 84 101 0.0613 99 0.0551 85 99 0.2287 72 0.4788 90 77 64 91 73 59 92 68 51 93 64 49 94 71 51 98 85 9 99 70 5 100 101 0.0749 68 0.9080 101 79 14 103 75 58 105 71 76 107 65 52 109 54 30 111 63 41 113 65 61 115 71 84 117 71 74 118 97 0.5108 81 0.5116 119 102 0.0769 101 0.0073 120 101 0.0255 90 0.2135 121 93 0.7017 93 0.1462 122 97 0.4817 32 >3 123 62 4 124 98 0.1193 93 0.1005 125 89 1.0892 93 0.1130 126 76 65 127 68 46 128 79 64 129 79 9 130 95 2.9475 47 >3 131 100 0.2659 38 >3 132 96 >3 96 1.4865 133 79 26 134 89 87 135 96 0.6679 97 0.1374 136 90 16 137 95 2.4325 95 0.9418 139 99 1.1500 96 0.5658 140 98 0.3375 90 0.3988 141 92 1.4740 55 2.0305 142 98 0.2942 97 0.0947 143 97 97 144 95 94 145 93 63 146 99 95 147 100 0.0668 99 0.0172 148 0.0390 149 0.0816 150 0.0337
Biological Example 22 Toxicity Data in Human Cell Lines
(366) The following compounds were tested for toxicity in human cell lines according to the preceding methods:
(367) TABLE-US-00020 TABLE 11 Toxicity data in human cell lines Cell Toxicity LD50 Results (μM) Observed Comp. HFF No. Toxicity HL60 CRL8155 SF539 HCC2998 1 <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM 2 <30% at 25 μM; 37% at 25 μM; <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM 11 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 12 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 3 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 5d <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 5g <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 20 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 7c 51% at 25 μM 54% at 25 μM 31% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM 7p 50% at 25 μM; 46% at 25 μM 84% at 25 μM; <30% at 25 μM 35% at 10 μM 54% at 10 μM 7t <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 5i <30% at 10 μM; <30% at 10 μM; <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM 7q <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 7r <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 5h <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 25 47% toxicity at 38% toxicity at 10 μM 10 μM 26 45% toxicity at 38% toxicity at 10 μM 10 μM 5p <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM <30% at 25 μM 5n <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 28 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM 29 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 30 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM 33 T at 100 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 30% at 10 μM 34 T at 100 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 6; 104% at 30% at 10 μM 10 μM 35 T at <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 25-100 μM 36 T at 100 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 37 T at 100 μM 38 T at 100 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 98% at 30 μM 98% at 30 μM 40 T at 100 μM 41 T at 100 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 42 T at 100 μM 44 T at 100 μM 46 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 69 T at 25 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 70 40% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 71 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 72 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 83 37% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 38% at 30 μM 46% at 30 μM 84 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 50% at 30 μM 48% at 30 μM 90 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 98 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 105 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 115 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 118 T at 6.25 & 25 μM 119 <30% at 10 μM; <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM 120 T at 25 μM 121 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM 122 <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM 124 T at 6.25 & 25 μM 147 60% at 30 μM; <30% at 30 μM 33% at 10 μM 148 49% at 30 μM; <30% at 30 μM <30% at 10 μM 149 <30% at 30 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM 150 T at 25 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 10 μM <30% at 30 μM <30% at 30 μM
Biological Example 23 Pharmacokinetics Properties
(368) The following compounds were tested for their solubility properties in buffers of various pH:
(369) TABLE-US-00021 TABLE 12 Pharmacokinetics properties Experimental PK/PD Analysis Results Oral Solubility (μM) Administration (IP Administration) Compound pH pH pH C.sub.max T.sub.max AUC No. 2.0 6.5 7.4 (μM) (min) (μM-min) 10 29 25.97 150 6725.59 2 43 2.4 1.5 7a 45 7q 19.71 30 2120.14 (3.8 IP) (30 IP) (275.86 IP) 7r 12 28 49 58 56 4.41 160 1228.15 (84.06 IP) (40 IP) (9050.27 IP) 29 34 47 49 6.64 120 1200.96 34 23 35 45 36 0.59 220 109.66 41 4.4 13.57 100 3172.19 42 4.4 10.69 160 2437.28 44 47 38 33 0.95 180 148.21 45 62 69 3 70 5 71 9 83 36 84 26 118 40 119 50 120 44 121 43 0.19 90 26.69 124 41 1.84 180 399.24 125 54 132 3.8 134 19.3 135 3.0 137 1.0 138 51 139 0.69 140 22 142 5.2 143 17 144 60 146 9 147 79 148 56 149 75 150 82
Biological Example 24 Biological Properties of Compound Nos. 29 and 150
(370) The compounds 29 and 150 were tested for their various biological properties according to the preceeding methods:
(371) TABLE-US-00022 TABLE 13 Biological properties of Compound Nos. 29 and 150 Enzymatic Assay IC.sub.50 Parasite Proliferation Assay Results (μM) EC.sub.50 Results (μM) Compound Tg Cp Pf P. falciparum No. CDPK1 CDPK1 CDPK4 T. gondii C. parvum Exflaggelation 29 0.003 0.001 0.004 0.052 0.56 0.04 150 0.003 0.001 0.010 0.137 0.54 0.05 Stability T.sub.1/2 (min) Oral (10 mg/kg Dose) Oral (50 mg/kg Dose) Compound Mouse Liver C.sub.max T.sub.max AUC C.sub.max T.sub.max AUC No. Microsomes (μM) (min) (μM-min) (μM) (min) (μM-min) 29 >60 0.2 140 57 1.1 160 311 150 >60 0.8 129 430 ND ND ND IP (10 mg/kg Dose) IP (50 mg/kg Dose) Compound C.sub.max T.sub.max AUC C.sub.max T.sub.max AUC No. (μM) (min) (μM-min) (μM) (min) (μM-min) 29 0.7 30 191 8.2 30 1769 150 3 40 863 ND ND ND
(372) Mice were dosed with 40 mg/kg of compound by oral gavages at 7 am, noon, and 3 μm on 4 consecutive days and blood levels determined by LC-MS. The first and fourth troughs refer to compound levels 17 hours after compound dosing taken at the beginning of d2 and d5. The first peak was 1 hr after the first dose. The fourth day peak was 1 hr after the third dose of d4. Mean±SD of N=3:
(373) TABLE-US-00023 Blood level (μM) Compound First Fourth D 4 Fourth No. First Peak Trough Peak Trough 29 0.05 ± 0.08 0 ± 0 6.6 ± 1.6 0 ± 0 150 2.1 ± 1.2 2.0 ± 1.6 8.9 ± 3.4 6.3 ± 1.8
REFERENCES (BIOLOGICAL EXAMPLES 1-11)
(374) The following references are herein incorporated by reference.
(375) 1. Montoya J G, Kovacs J A & Remington J S. Principles and Practice of Infectious Diseases. Chapter 276 Mandell, B. & D. (ed.) (Churchill Livingston, 2005). 2. Mead, P. S. et al. Food-related illness and death in the United States. Emerging Infectious Diseases 5, 607-625 (1999). 3. Baril, L. et al. Risk factors for toxoplasma infection in pregnancy: A case-control study in France. Scandinavian Journal of Infectious Diseases 31, 305-309 (1999). 4. Jones, J. L. et al. Toxoplasma gondii infection in the United States: Seroprevalence and risk factors. American Journal of Epidemiology 154, 357-365 (2001). 5. Wallace, M. R., Rossetti, R. J. & Olson, P. E. Cats and Toxoplasmosis Risk in Hiv-Infected Adults. Jama—Journal of the American Medical Association 269, 76-77 (1993). 6. Vastava, P. B. et al. MRI features of toxoplasma encephalitis in the immunocompetent host: a report of two cases. Neuroradiology 44, 834-838 (2002). 7. Hermentin, K., Hassl, A., Picher, O. & Aspock, H. Comparison of Different Serotests for Specific Toxoplasma Igm-Antibodies (Isaga, Spiha, Ifat) and Detection of Circulating Antigen in 2 Cases of Laboratory Acquired Toxoplasma Infection. Zentralblatt fur Bakteriologie Mikrobiologie und Hygiene Series A-Medical Microbiology Infectious Diseases Virology Parasitology 270, 534-541 (1989). 8. Bach, M. C. & Armstrong, R. M. Acute Toxoplasmic Encephalitis in A Normal Adult. Archives of Neurology 40, 596-597 (1983). 9. Pelphrey, P. M. et al. Highly efficient ligands for dihydrofolate reductase from Cryptosporidium hominis and Toxoplasma gondii inspired by structural analysis. Journal of Medicinal Chemistry 50, 940-950 (2007). 10. Dannemann, B. et al. Treatment of Toxoplasmic Encephalitis in Patients with Aids—A Randomized Trial Comparing Pyrimethamine Plus Clindamycin to Pyrimethamine Plus Sulfadiazine. Annals of Internal Medicine 116, 33-43 (1992). 11. JEFFREY M. JACOBSON et al. Pyrimethamine Pharmacokinetics in Human Immunodeficiency Virus-Positive Patients Seropositive for Toxoplasma gondii. ANTIMICROBIAL AGENTS AND CHEMOTHERAPY 40, 1360-1365 (1996). 12. Nagamune, K. & Sibley, L. D. Comparative genomic and phylogenetic analyses of calcium ATPases and calcium-regulated proteins in the apicomplexa. Mol. Biol. Evol. 23, 1613-1627 (2006). 13. Lovett, J. L. & Sibley, L. D. Intracellular calcium stores in Toxoplasma gondii govern invasion of host cells. Journal of Cell Science 116, 3009-3016 (2003). 14. Kieschnick, H., Wakefield, T., Narducci, C. A. & Beckers, C. Toxoplasma gondii attachment to host cells is regulated by a calmodulin-like domain protein kinase. J Biol. Chem. 276, 12369-12377 (2001). 15. Canduri, F., Perez, P. C., Caceres, R. A. & de Azevedo, W. F. Protein kinases as targets for antiparasitic chemotherapy drugs. Current Drug Targets 8, 389-398 (2007). 16. Doerig, C., Billker, O., Pratt, D. & Endicott, J. Protein kinases as targets for antimalarial intervention: kinomics, structure-based design, transmission-blockade, and targeting host cell enzymes. Biophysica et Biochimica Acta—Proteins and Proteomics 1754, 132-150 (2005). 17. Harper, J. F. & Harmon, A. Plants, symbiosis and parasites: A calcium signaling connection. Nature Reviews Molecular Cell Biology 6, 555-566 (2005). 18. Raichaudhuri, A., Bhattacharyya, R., Chaudhuri, S., Chakrabarti, P. & Dasgupta, M. Domain analysis of a groundnut calcium-dependent protein kinase: nuclear localization sequence in the junction domain is coupled with nonconsensus calcium binding domains. J Biol. Chem. 281, 10399-10409 (2006). 19. Noble, M. E., Endicott, J. A. & Johnson, L. N. Protein kinase inhibitors: insights into drug design from structure. Science 303, 1800-1805 (2004). 20. Knight, Z. A. & Shokat, K. M. Features of selective kinase inhibitors. Chemistry &Biology 12, 621-637 (2005). 21. Cohen, M. S., Zhang, C., Shokat, K. M. & Taunton, J. Structural bioinformatics-based design of selective, irreversible kinase inhibitors. Science 308, 1318-1321 (2005). 22. Liao, J. J. Molecular recognition of protein kinase binding pockets for design of potent and selective kinase inhibitors. J. Med. Chem. 50, 409-424 (2007). 23. Bishop, A. C. et al. A chemical switch for inhibitor-sensitive alleles of any protein kinase. Nature 407, 395-401 (2000). 24. Bishop, A. C. et al. Generation of monospecific nanomolar tyrosine kinase inhibitors via a chemical genetic approach. Journal of the American Chemical Society 121, 627-631 (1999). 25. Zhang, C. et al. A second-site suppressor strategy for chemical genetic analysis of diverse protein kinases. Nat. Methods 2, 435-441 (2005). 26. Bishop, A. C., Buzko, O. & Shokat, K. M. Magic bullets for protein kinases. Trends Cell Biol. 11, 167-172 (2001). 27. Johnson, A. W. et al. The brain-derived neurotrophic factor receptor TrkB is critical for the acquisition but not expression of conditioned incentive value. European Journal of Neuroscience 28, 997-1002 (2008). 28. Morgan, D. J. et al. Tissue-specific PKA inhibition using a chemical genetic approach and its application to studies on sperm capacitation. Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences of the United States of America 105, 20740-20745 (2008). 29. Chen, X. et al. A chemical-genetic approach to studying neurotrophin signaling. Neuron 46, 13-21 (2005). 30. Ojo, K. K. et al. Glycogen synthase kinase 3 is a potential drug target for African trypanosomiasis therapy. Antimicrob. Agents Chemother. 52, 3710-3717 (2008). 31. Newman, J. et al. Towards rationalization of crystallization screening for small- to medium-sized academic laboratories: the PACT/JCSG plus strategy. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 61, 1426-1431 (2005). 32. Cohen, A. E., Ellis, P. J., Miller, M. D., Deacon, A. M. & Phizackerley, R. P. An automated system to mount cryo-cooled protein crystals on a synchrotron beamline, using compact sample cassettes and a small-scale robot. Journal of Applied Crystallography 35, 720-726 (2002). 33. McPhillips, T. M. et al. Blu-Ice and the Distributed Control System: software for data acquisition and instrument control at macromolecular crystallography beamlines. Journal of Synchrotron Radiation 9, 401-406 (2002). 34. Hendrickson, W. A., Horton, J. R. & Lemaster, D. M. Selenomethionyl Proteins Produced for Analysis by Multiwavelength Anomalous Diffraction (Mad)—A Vehicle for Direct Determination of 3-Dimensional Structure. Embo Journal 9, 1665-1672 (1990). 35. Otwinowski, Z. & Minor, W. Processing of X-ray diffraction data collected in oscillation mode. Macromolecular Crystallography, Pt A 276, 307-326 (1997). 36. Vagin, A. & Teplyakov, A. MOLREP: an automated program for molecular replacement. Journal of Applied Crystallography 30, 1022-1025 (1997). 37. Mccoy, A. J. et al. Phaser crystallographic software. Journal of Applied Crystallography 40, 658-674 (2007). 38. Terwilliger, T. SOLVE and RESOLVE: automated structure solution, density modification, and model building. Journal of Synchrotron Radiation 11, 49-52 (2004). 39. Emsley, P. & Cowtan, K. Coot: model-building tools for molecular graphics. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 60, 2126-2132 (2004). 40. Murshudov, G. N., Vagin, A. A. & Dodson, E. J. Refinement of macromolecular structures by the maximum-likelihood method. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 53, 240-255 (1997). 41. Cohen, S. X. et al. ARP/wARP and molecular replacement: the next generation. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 64, 49-60 (2008). 42. Schuttelkopf, A. W. & van Aalten, D. M. F. PRODRG: a tool for high-throughput crystallography of protein-ligand complexes. Acta Crystallographica Section D Biological Crystallography 60, 1355-1363 (2004). 43. Painter, J. & Merritt, E. A. Optimal description of a protein structure in terms of multiple groups undergoing TLS motion. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 62, 439-450 (2006). 44. Painter, J. & Merritt, E. A. TLSMD web server for the generation of multi-group TLS models. Journal of Applied Crystallography 39, 109-111 (2006). 45. Lovell, S. C. et al. Structure validation by C alpha geometry: phi, psi and C beta deviation. Proteins-Structure Function and Genetics 50, 437-450 (2003). 46. Bailey, S. The Ccp4 Suite—Programs for Protein Crystallography. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 50, 760-763 (1994). 47. Potterton, E., Briggs, P., Turkenburg, M. & Dodson, E. A graphical user interface to the CCP4 program suite. Acta Crystallographica Section D-Biological Crystallography 59, 1131-1137 (2003). 48. Berman, H. M. et al. The Protein Data Bank. Nucleic Acids Research 28, 235-242 (2000). 49. Matrajt, M., Nishi, M., Fraunholz, M. J., Peter, O. & Roos, D. S. Amino-terminal control of transgenic protein expression levels in Toxoplasma gondii. Molecular and Biochemical Parasitology 120, 285-289 (2002). 50. Striepen, B., He, C. Y. X., Matrajt, M., Soldati, D. & Roos, D. S. Expression, selection, and organellar targeting of the green fluorescent protein in Toxoplasma gondii. Molecular and Biochemical Parasitology 92, 325-338 (1998). 51. DeRocher, A., Hagen, C. B., Froehlich, J. E., Feagin, J. E. & Parsons, M. Analysis of targeting sequences demonstrates that trafficking to the Toxoplasma gondii plastid branches off the secretory system. Journal of Cell Science 113, 3969-3977 (2000). 52. Karnataki, A. et al. Cell cycle-regulated vesicular trafficking of Toxoplasma APT1, a protein localized to multiple apicoplast membranes. Molecular Microbiology 63, 1653-1668 (2007). 53. Fruth, I. A. & Arrizabalaga, G. Toxoplasma gondii: Induction of egress by the potassium ionophore nigericin. International Journal for Parasitology 37, 1559-1567 (2007). 54. Seeber, F. & Boothroyd, J. C. Escherichia coli beta-galactosidase as an in vitro and in vivo reporter enzyme and stable transfection marker in the intracellular protozoan parasite Toxoplasma gondii. Gene 169, 39-45 (1996).
REFERENCES (SYNTHETIC EXAMPLES AND BIOLOGICAL EXAMPLES 12 ETC.)
(376) The following references are herein incorporated by reference. 1. White A C. Chapter 280: Cryptosporidiosis (Cryptosporidium hominis, Cryptosporidium parvum, and Other Species) in Mandell, Bennett, & Dolin: Principles and Practice of Infectious Diseases, 6th ed. Publ: Churchill Livingston (2005). 2. Samie, A.; Bessong, P. O.; Obi, C. L.; Sevilleja, J. E.; Stroup, S.; Houpt, E.; Guerrant, R. L. Cryptosporidium species: preliminary descriptions of the prevalence and genotype distribution among school children and hospital patients in the Venda region, Limpopo Province, South Africa. Exp. Parasitol. 114, 314-322 (2006). 3. Montoya J G, Kovacs J A, Remington J S. Chapter 276: Toxoplasma gondii in Mandell, Bennett, &Dolin: Principles and Practice of Infectious Diseases, 6th ed. Publ: Churchill Livingston (2005). 4. Nagamune K, Sibley L D. Comparative genomic and phylogenetic analyses of calcium ATPases and calcium-regulated proteins in the apicomplexa. Mol. Biol. Evol. 23, 1613-1627 (2006). 5. Billker O, Lourido S, Sibley L D. Cell Host Microbe. 2009 Jun. 18; 5(6):612-22. Calcium-dependent signaling and kinases in apicomplexan parasites. 6. Doerig C, Billker O, Pratt D, Endicott J. Protein kinases as targets for antimalarial intervention: kinomics, structure-based design, transmission-blockade, and targeting host cell enzymes. Biophysica et Biochimica Acta—Proteins and Proteomics 1754, 132-150 (2005). 7. Kieschnick H, Wakefield T, Narducci C A, Beckers, C. Toxoplasma gondii attachment to host cells is regulated by a calmodulin-like domain protein kinase. J Biol. Chem. 276, 12369-12377 (2001). 8. Chen X M, O'Hara S P, Huang B Q, Nelson J B, Lin J J C, Zhu G, Ward H D, LaRusso N F. Apical Organelle discharge by Cryptosporidium parvum is temperature, cytoskeleton, and intracellular calcium dependent and required for host cell invasion. Infect. Immun. 72, 6806-16 (2004). 9. Ojo K K, Larson, E T, Keyloun K R, Castaneda L J, DeRocher A E, Inampudi K K, Kim J E, Arakaki T, Murphy, R C, Zhang L, Napuli A J, Maly D J, Verlinde CLMJ, Buckner F S, Parsons M, Hol W G J, Merritt E A, Van Voorhis W C. Toxoplasma gondii calcium-dependent protein kinase 1 is a target for selective kinase inhibitors Nat. Struct. Mol. Biol. 17, 602-607 (2010). 10. Sugi T, Kato K, Kobayashi K, Watanabe S, Kurokawa H, Gong H, Pandey K, Takemae H, Akashi H. Use of the kinase inhibitor analog 1NM-PP1 reveals a role for Toxoplasma gondii CDPK1 in the invasion step. Eukaryot. Cell 9, 667-70 (2010). 11. Liao, J. J. Molecular recognition of protein kinase binding pockets for design of potent and selective kinase inhibitors. J. Med. Chem. 50, 409-424 (2007). 12. Zhang, C. et al. A second-site suppressor strategy for chemical genetic analysis of diverse protein kinases. Nat. Methods 2, 435-441 (2005). 13. Cohen, M. S. et al. Structural bioinformatics-based design of selective, irreversible kinase inhibitors. Science 308, 1318-1321 (2005). 14. Bishop, A. C. et al. A chemical switch for inhibitor-sensitive alleles of any protein kinase. Nature 407, 395-401 (2000). 15. Bishop, A. C. et al. Design of allele-specific inhibitors to probe protein kinase signaling. Curr. Biol. 8, 257-266 (1998). 16. Bishop, A C. et al. Generation of monospecific nanomolar tyrosine kinase inhibitors via a chemical genetic approach. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 121, 627-631 (1999). 17. Burchat A F, Calderwood D J, Friedman M M, Hirst G C, Li B, Rafferty P, Ritter K, Skinner B S. “Pyrazolo[3,4-d]pyrimidines containing an extended 3-substituent as potent inhibitors of Lck—a selectivity insight” Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 12, 1687-1690 (2002). 18. Apsel, B, Blair, J A, Gonzalez B, Nazif™, Feldman M E, Aizenstein B, Hoffman R, Williams R. L, Shokat K M, Knight Z A. “Targeted polypharmacology: discovery of dual inhibitors of tyrosine and phosphoinositide kinases” Nat. Chem. Biol., 4, 691-699 (2008). 19. Valeur, E.; Roche, D. Efficient, mild, parallel and purification-free synthesis of aryl ethers via Mitsunobu reaction. Tet. Lett. 49, 4182-4185 (2008). 20. CpCDPK1's and TgCDPK1's K.sub.ms for ATP are 9.0 μM and 10 μM, respectively 21. Hanke J H, Gardner J P, Dow R L, Changelian P L, Brissette W H, Weringer E J, Pollok B A, Connelly P A. “Discovery of a novel, potent, and Src family-selective tyrosine kinase inhibitor. Study of Lck- and FynT-dependent T cell activation.” J Biol. Chem., 271, 695-701 (1996). 22. Ajjampur, S. S.; Rajendran, P.; Ramani, S.; Banerjee, I.; Monica, B.; Sankaran, P.; Rosario, V.; Arumugam, R.; Sarkar, R.; Ward, H.; Kang, G. Closing the diarrhea diagnostic gap in Indian children by the application of molecular techniques. J Med. Microbiol. 57, 1364-1368 (2008). 23. K. K. Ojo et al., Structure determination of glycogen synthase kinase-3 from Leishmania major and comparative inhibitor structure-activity relationships with Trypanosoma brucei GSK-3. Mol. Biochem. Parasitol. 176, 98-108 (2011). 24. R. C. Murphy et al., Discovery of Potent and Selective Inhibitors of CDPK1 from C. parvum and T. gondii. ACS Med. Chem. Lett. 1, 331-335 (2010). 25. A. Roy, A. Kucukural, Y. Zhang, I-TASSER: a unified platform for automated protein structure and function prediction. Nat. Protoc. 5, 725-738 (2010). 26. Y. Zhang, I-TASSER server for protein 3D structure prediction. BMC Bioinform. 9, 40 (2008). 27. C. McMartin, R. S. Bohacek, QXP: powerful, rapid computer algorithms for structure-based drug design. J. Comput. Aided Mol. Des 11, 333-344 (1997). 28. E. Krissinel, K. Henrick, Secondary-structure matching (SSM), a new tool for fast protein structure alignment in three dimensions. Acta Crystallogr. D Biol. Crystallogr. 60, 2256-2268 (2004). 29. C. J. Janse, J. Ramesar, A. P. Waters, High-efficiency transfection and drug selection of genetically transformed blood stages of the rodent malaria parasite Plasmodium berghei. Nat. Protoc. 1, 346-356 (2006). 30. R. W. Moon et al., A cyclic GMP signalling module that regulates gliding motility in a malaria parasite. PLoS Pathog. 5, e1000599 (2009). 31. C. J. Janse, B. Franke-Fayard, A. P. Waters, Selection by flow-sorting of genetically transformed, GFP-expressing blood stages of the rodent malaria parasite, Plasmodium berghei. Nat. Protoc. 1, 614-623 (2006).
CONCLUSION
(377) The description of embodiments of the disclosure is not intended to be exhaustive or to limit the disclosure to the precise form disclosed. While specific embodiments of, and examples for, the disclosure are described herein for illustrative purposes, various equivalent modifications are possible within the scope of the disclosure, as those skilled in the relevant art will recognize.
(378) All of the references cited herein are incorporated by reference. Aspects of the disclosure can be modified, if necessary, to employ the systems, functions and concepts of the above references and application to provide yet further embodiments of the disclosure. These and other changes can be made to the disclosure in light of the detailed description.
(379) Specific elements of any of the foregoing embodiments can be combined or substituted for elements in other embodiments. Furthermore, while advantages associated with certain embodiments of the disclosure have been described in the context of these embodiments, other embodiments may also exhibit such advantages, and not all embodiments need necessarily exhibit such advantages to fall within the scope of the disclosure. Accordingly, the disclosure is not limited, except as by the appended claims.